blob: fcc6454d3a6aaea7656ac240f1d5462db327eca8 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau4dfb7952014-06-24 11:30:21 +02005 version 1.5.1
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau4dfb7952014-06-24 11:30:21 +02007 2014/06/24
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200500 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100501 - tune.zlib.memlevel
502 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 * Debugging
505 - debug
506 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507
508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005093.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200510------------------------------------
511
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200512ca-base <dir>
513 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200514 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
515 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517chroot <jail dir>
518 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
519 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
520 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
521 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
522 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
523 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100524
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100525cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
526 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
527 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
528 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100529 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
530 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
531 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
532 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
533 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
534 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
535 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
536 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
537 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
538 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100539
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200540crt-base <dir>
541 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
542 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
543 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
544
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545daemon
546 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
547 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
548 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
549
550gid <number>
551 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
552 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
553 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100554 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
555 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100557
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558group <group name>
559 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
560 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100561
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200562log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
564 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100565 configured with "log global".
566
567 <address> can be one of:
568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100569 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100570 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
571 port).
572
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100573 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
574 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
575 port).
576
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100577 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
578 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
579 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
580 writeable).
581
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100582 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
583 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
584 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
585 in Bourne shell.
586
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200587 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
588 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
589 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
590 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
591 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
592 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
593 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
594 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
595 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
596 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
597 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
598
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100599 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600
601 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
602 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
603 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
604
605 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200606 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
607 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
608 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
609 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
610 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
611 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200613 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100615log-send-hostname [<string>]
616 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
617 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
618 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
619 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
620 the logs.
621
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000622log-tag <string>
623 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
624 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
625 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
626 running on the same host.
627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628nbproc <number>
629 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
630 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
631 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
632 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
633 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
634
635pidfile <pidfile>
636 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
637 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
638 starting the process. See also "daemon".
639
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100640stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200641 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
642 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
643 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
644 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
645 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
646 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100647 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200648 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
649 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200650
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100651ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
653 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300654 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100655 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
656 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
657 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
658 "bind" keyword for more information.
659
660ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
662 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300663 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100664 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
665 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
666 information.
667
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100668ssl-server-verify [none|required]
669 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
670 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
671 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
672
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200673stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
674 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
675 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
676 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
677 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200678
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200679 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
680 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
681 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200682
683stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
684 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
685 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100686 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200687
688stats maxconn <connections>
689 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
690 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200692uid <number>
693 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
694 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
695 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
696 one. See also "gid" and "user".
697
698ulimit-n <number>
699 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
700 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
701 option.
702
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100703unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
704 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
705
706 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
707 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
708 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
709 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
710 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
711 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
712 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
713 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
714 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
715 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200717user <user name>
718 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
719 See also "uid" and "group".
720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200721node <name>
722 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
723
724 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
725 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
726 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
727 traffic.
728
729description <text>
730 Add a text that describes the instance.
731
732 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
733 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
734 "<" and ">" characters.
735
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200736
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007373.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200738-----------------------
739
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200740max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
741 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
742 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
743 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
744 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
745 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
746 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
747 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
748 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200750maxconn <number>
751 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
752 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
753 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200754 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
755 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
756 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
757 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
758 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200759
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200760maxconnrate <number>
761 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
762 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
763 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
764 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
765 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
766 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
767 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
768 fairness.
769
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100770maxcomprate <number>
771 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300772 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100773 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
774 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
775 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
776 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
777 default value.
778
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100779maxcompcpuusage <number>
780 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
781 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
782 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
783 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
784 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
785 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
786 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
787 process down and from introducing high latencies.
788
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100789maxpipes <number>
790 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
791 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
792 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
793 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
794 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
795 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
796
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200797maxsessrate <number>
798 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
799 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
800 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
801 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
802 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
803 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
804 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
805 fairness.
806
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200807maxsslconn <number>
808 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
809 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
810 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
811 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
812 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
813 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
814 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
815
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200816maxsslrate <number>
817 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
818 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
819 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
820 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
821 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
822 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
823 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
824 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
825 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
826 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
827
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100828maxzlibmem <number>
829 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
830 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
831 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100832 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
833 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
834 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
835
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200836noepoll
837 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
838 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100839 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200840
841nokqueue
842 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
843 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
844 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
845
846nopoll
847 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
848 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100849 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100850 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200851
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100852nosplice
853 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
854 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
855 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100856 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100857 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
858 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
859 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
860 "option splice-response".
861
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300862nogetaddrinfo
863 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
864 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
865
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200866spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900867 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
868 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
869 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
870 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
871 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
872 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200873
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200874tune.bufsize <number>
875 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
876 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
877 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
878 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
879 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
880 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
881 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
882 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400883 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
884 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
885 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200886
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200887tune.chksize <number>
888 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
889 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
890 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
891 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
892 checks whenever possible.
893
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100894tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
895 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
896 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
897 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
898 this value. The default value is 1.
899
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100900tune.http.cookielen <number>
901 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
902 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
903 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
904 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
905 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
906 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
907 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
908 to change this value.
909
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200910tune.http.maxhdr <number>
911 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
912 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
913 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
914 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
915 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
916 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
917 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
918 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
919 limit too high.
920
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100921tune.idletimer <timeout>
922 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
923 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
924 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
925 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
926 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
927 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
928 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
929 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
930 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
931
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100932tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100933 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
934 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
935 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
936 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
937 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
938 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
939 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
940 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
941 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
942 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100943
944tune.maxpollevents <number>
945 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
946 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
947 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
948 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
949 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
950
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200951tune.maxrewrite <number>
952 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
953 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
954 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
955 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
956 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
957 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
958 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
959 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
960 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
961 bufsize.
962
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200963tune.pipesize <number>
964 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
965 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
966 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
967 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
968 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
969 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
970
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100971tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
972tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
973 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
974 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
975 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
976 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
977 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
978 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
979 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
980
981tune.sndbuf.client <number>
982tune.sndbuf.server <number>
983 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
984 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
985 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
986 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
987 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
988 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
989 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
990 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
991 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
992 notifying haproxy again.
993
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100994tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100995 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
996 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
997 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300998 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100999 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1000 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1001 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1002 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1003 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001004 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1005 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001006
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001007tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1008 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1009 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1010 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1011 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1012 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1013 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1014
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001015tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1016 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001017 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001018 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1019 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1020 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1021 being used for too long.
1022
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001023tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1024 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1025 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1026 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1027 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1028 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1029 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1030 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1031 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1032 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1033 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001034 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1035 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001036
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001037tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1038 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1039 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1040 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1041 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1042 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1043 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1044 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1045 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1046
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001047tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1048 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001049 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001050 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1051 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1052 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1053
1054tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1055 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1056 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1057 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1058 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010603.3. Debugging
1061--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001062
1063debug
1064 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1065 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1066 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1067 system startup.
1068
1069quiet
1070 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1071 line argument "-q".
1072
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010743.4. Userlists
1075--------------
1076It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1077http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1078it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1079
1080userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001081 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001082 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1083
1084group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001085 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001086 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1087 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1088
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001089user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1090 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001091 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1092 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001093 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1094 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001095 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001096 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001097
1098
1099 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001100 userlist L1
1101 group G1 users tiger,scott
1102 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001103
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001104 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1105 user scott insecure-password elgato
1106 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001107
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001108 userlist L2
1109 group G1
1110 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001111
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001112 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1113 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1114 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001115
1116 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001117
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001118
11193.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001120----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001121It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1122haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1123pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1124identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1125or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1126Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1127known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1128the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1129process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1130during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1131tables.
1132
1133peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001134 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001135 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1136
1137peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1138 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1139 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1140 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1141 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1142 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1143 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1144
1145 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1146 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1147
1148 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1149 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1150 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1151 across all peers.
1152
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001153 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1154 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1155 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1156
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001157 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001158 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001159 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1160 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1161 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001162
1163 backend mybackend
1164 mode tcp
1165 balance roundrobin
1166 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1167 stick on src
1168
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001169 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1170 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001171
1172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011734. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001174----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001175
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001176Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1177 - defaults <name>
1178 - frontend <name>
1179 - backend <name>
1180 - listen <name>
1181
1182A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1183its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1184section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001185section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001186
1187A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1188connections.
1189
1190A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1191to forward incoming connections.
1192
1193A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1194parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1195
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001196All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1197'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1198case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1199
1200Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1201logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1202proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1203However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1204name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1205
1206Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1207and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001208bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001209protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1210modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1211arbitrary criteria.
1212
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001213In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1214a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1215the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1216
1217 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1218 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1219 between responses and new requests.
1220
1221 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1222 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1223 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1224 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1225
1226 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1227 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1228 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1229
1230 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1231 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1232 client-facing connection remains open.
1233
1234 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1235 after the end of the response.
1236
1237The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1238frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1239following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1240weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1241
1242 Backend mode
1243
1244 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1245 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1246 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1247 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1248 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1249 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1250 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1251 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1252 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1253 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1254 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1255
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001256
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1259--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001261The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1262limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1263they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1264limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001265marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001266option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001267and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1268with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1269specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001270
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001271
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001272 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1273------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1274acl - X X X
1275appsession - - X X
1276backlog X X X -
1277balance X - X X
1278bind - X X -
1279bind-process X X X X
1280block - X X X
1281capture cookie - X X -
1282capture request header - X X -
1283capture response header - X X -
1284clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001285compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001286contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1287cookie X - X X
1288default-server X - X X
1289default_backend X X X -
1290description - X X X
1291disabled X X X X
1292dispatch - - X X
1293enabled X X X X
1294errorfile X X X X
1295errorloc X X X X
1296errorloc302 X X X X
1297-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1298errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001299force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001300fullconn X - X X
1301grace X X X X
1302hash-type X - X X
1303http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001304http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001305http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001306http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001307http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001308http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001309id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001310ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001311log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001312max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001313maxconn X X X -
1314mode X X X X
1315monitor fail - X X -
1316monitor-net X X X -
1317monitor-uri X X X -
1318option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1319option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1320option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1321option allbackups (*) X - X X
1322option checkcache (*) X - X X
1323option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1324option contstats (*) X X X -
1325option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1326option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1327option forceclose (*) X X X X
1328-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1329option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001330option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001331option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001332option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001333option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001334option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001335option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1336option httpchk X - X X
1337option httpclose (*) X X X X
1338option httplog X X X X
1339option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001340option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001341option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001342option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1343option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1344option logasap (*) X X X -
1345option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001346option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001347option nolinger (*) X X X X
1348option originalto X X X X
1349option persist (*) X - X X
1350option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001351option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001352option smtpchk X - X X
1353option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1354option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1355option splice-request (*) X X X X
1356option splice-response (*) X X X X
1357option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1358option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1359-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001360option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001361option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1362option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1363option tcpka X X X X
1364option tcplog X X X X
1365option transparent (*) X - X X
1366persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1367rate-limit sessions X X X -
1368redirect - X X X
1369redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1370redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1371reqadd - X X X
1372reqallow - X X X
1373reqdel - X X X
1374reqdeny - X X X
1375reqiallow - X X X
1376reqidel - X X X
1377reqideny - X X X
1378reqipass - X X X
1379reqirep - X X X
1380reqisetbe - X X X
1381reqitarpit - X X X
1382reqpass - X X X
1383reqrep - X X X
1384-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1385reqsetbe - X X X
1386reqtarpit - X X X
1387retries X - X X
1388rspadd - X X X
1389rspdel - X X X
1390rspdeny - X X X
1391rspidel - X X X
1392rspideny - X X X
1393rspirep - X X X
1394rsprep - X X X
1395server - - X X
1396source X - X X
1397srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001398stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001399stats auth X - X X
1400stats enable X - X X
1401stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001402stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001403stats realm X - X X
1404stats refresh X - X X
1405stats scope X - X X
1406stats show-desc X - X X
1407stats show-legends X - X X
1408stats show-node X - X X
1409stats uri X - X X
1410-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1411stick match - - X X
1412stick on - - X X
1413stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001414stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001415stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001416tcp-check connect - - X X
1417tcp-check expect - - X X
1418tcp-check send - - X X
1419tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001420tcp-request connection - X X -
1421tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001422tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001423tcp-response content - - X X
1424tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001425timeout check X - X X
1426timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001427timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001428timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1429timeout connect X - X X
1430timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1431timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1432timeout http-request X X X X
1433timeout queue X - X X
1434timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001435timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001436timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1437timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001438timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001439transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001440unique-id-format X X X -
1441unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001442use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001443use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001444------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1445 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014484.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1449---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001450
1451This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1452
1453
1454acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1455 Declare or complete an access list.
1456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1457 no | yes | yes | yes
1458 Example:
1459 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1460 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1461 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001463 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001464
1465
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001466appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1467 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001468 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1470 no | no | yes | yes
1471 Arguments :
1472 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1473 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1474
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001475 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001476 checked in each cookie value.
1477
1478 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1479 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1480 milliseconds.
1481
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001482 request-learn
1483 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1484 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1485 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1486 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1487 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1488 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1489
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001490 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1491 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1492 data following this prefix.
1493
1494 Example :
1495 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1496
1497 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1498 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1499
1500 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1501 2 modes are currently supported :
1502 - path-parameters :
1503 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1504 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1505 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1506 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1507 - query-string :
1508 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1509 query string.
1510
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001511 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1512 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1513 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1514 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001515 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1516 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1517 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001518 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1519 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1520
1521 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1522
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001523 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1524 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1525 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1526
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001527 Example :
1528 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1529
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001530 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1531 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001532
1533
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001534backlog <conns>
1535 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1537 yes | yes | yes | no
1538 Arguments :
1539 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1540 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001541 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001542
1543 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1544 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1545 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1546 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1547 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1548 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1549 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1550 backlog parameter.
1551
1552 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1553 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1554 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1555
1556 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1557
1558
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001559balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001560balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001561 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1563 yes | no | yes | yes
1564 Arguments :
1565 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1566 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1567 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1568 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1569
1570 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1571 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1572 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1573 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001574 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001575 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001576 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1577 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1578 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1579 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1580 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1581 it, so that you don't worry.
1582
1583 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1584 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1585 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1586 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1587 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1588 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1589 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1590 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001591
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001592 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1593 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1594 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1595 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1596 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1597 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1598 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1599 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1600
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001601 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001602 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001603 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1604 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001605 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001606 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1607 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1608 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1609 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1610 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001611 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1612 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1613 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1614 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1615 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1616 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001618 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1619 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1620 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1621 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1622 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1623 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1624 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1625 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001626 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001627 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001628 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1629 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1630 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001631
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001632 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1633 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1634 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1635 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1636 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1637 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1638 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1639 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1640 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1641 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1642 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1643 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001644
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001645 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001646 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1647 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1648 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1649 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1650 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1651 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1652 URIs start with a leading "/".
1653
1654 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1655 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1656 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1657 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1658
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001659 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001660 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1661
1662 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001663 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1664 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001665 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1666 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1667 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1668 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001669 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001670 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1671 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001672
1673 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1674 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1675 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1676 server will receive the request.
1677
1678 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1679 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1680 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1681 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1682 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001683 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1684 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1685 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001686
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001687 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1688 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1689 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1690 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1691 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001692
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001693 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001694 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1695 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1696 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1697
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001698 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1699 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1700 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1701
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001702 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001703 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001704 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1705 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1706 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1707 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1708 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1709 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001710 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001711 used instead.
1712
1713 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1714 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1715 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1716 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1717
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001718 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1719 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1720 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1721
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001722 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001723
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001724 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001725 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1726 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001727
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001728 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1729 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1730 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001731
1732 Examples :
1733 balance roundrobin
1734 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001735 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001736 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1737 balance hdr(host)
1738 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001739
1740 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1741 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1742
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001743 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001744 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1745 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1746 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1747 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1748
1749 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1750 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1751 defaults to 16 kB.
1752
1753 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1754 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1755
1756 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1757 Round Robin.
1758
1759 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1760 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1761 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1762 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1763
1764 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1765
1766 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001767 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001768 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1769 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1770 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001771
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001772 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1773 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001774
1775
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001776bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1777bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001778 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1780 no | yes | yes | no
1781 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001782 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1783 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1784 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1785 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001786 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001787 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1788 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1789 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1790 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1791 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1792 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1793 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02001794 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001795 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1796 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1797 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001798 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1799 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1800 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1801 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001802
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001803 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1804 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001805 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1806 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1807 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001808 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1809 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1810 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1811 the range.
1812
1813 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1814 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1815 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1816 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1817 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1818 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1819 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001820 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001821 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001822
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001823 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1824 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1825 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1826 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1827 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1828 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1829 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1830 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1831
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001832 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1833 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1834 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1835 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001836
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001837 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1838 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1839 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1840 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1841 in a frontend.
1842
1843 Example :
1844 listen http_proxy
1845 bind :80,:443
1846 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001847 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001848
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001849 listen http_https_proxy
1850 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001851 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001852
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001853 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1854 bind ipv6@:80
1855 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1856 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1857
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001858 listen external_bind_app1
1859 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1860
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001861 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001862 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001863
1864
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001865bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001866 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1868 yes | yes | yes | yes
1869 Arguments :
1870 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1871 may be used to override a default value.
1872
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001873 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001874 option may be combined with other numbers.
1875
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001876 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001877 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1878 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1879 missing from all processes.
1880
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001881 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001882 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001883 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1884 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1885 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1886 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001887
1888 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1889 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1890 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1891 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1892 and 'even' instances.
1893
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001894 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1895 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1896 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1897 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001898
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001899 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1900 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1901
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001902 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1903 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1904
1905 Example :
1906 listen app_ip1
1907 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001908 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001909
1910 listen app_ip2
1911 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001912 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001913
1914 listen management
1915 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001916 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001917
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001918 listen management
1919 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1920 bind-process 1-4
1921
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001922 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001923
1924
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001925block { if | unless } <condition>
1926 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1928 no | yes | yes | yes
1929
1930 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1931 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001932 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001933 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001934 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1935 "block" statements per instance.
1936
1937 Example:
1938 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1939 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1940 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1941 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1942
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001943 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001944
1945
1946capture cookie <name> len <length>
1947 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1949 no | yes | yes | no
1950 Arguments :
1951 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1952 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1953 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1954 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1955 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1956
1957 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1958 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1959 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1960 right if it exceeds <length>.
1961
1962 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1963 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1964 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1965 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1966
1967 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1968 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1969 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1970
1971 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1972 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1973 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001974 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1975 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1976 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001977
1978 Example:
1979 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1980
1981 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001982 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001983
1984
1985capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001986 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1988 no | yes | yes | no
1989 Arguments :
1990 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001991 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001992 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1993 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1994 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1995
1996 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1997 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1998 it exceeds <length>.
1999
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002000 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002001 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2002 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002003 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2004 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2005 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2006 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002007 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002008 environments to find where the request came from.
2009
2010 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2011 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2012 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2013 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002014
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002015 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2016 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2017 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2018 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2019 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020
2021 Example:
2022 capture request header Host len 15
2023 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2024 capture request header Referrer len 15
2025
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002026 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002027 about logging.
2028
2029
2030capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002031 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2033 no | yes | yes | no
2034 Arguments :
2035 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002036 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002037 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2038 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2039 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2040
2041 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2042 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2043 it exceeds <length>.
2044
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002045 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002046 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2047 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2048 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002049 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2050 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2051 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2052 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002053
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002054 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2055 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2056 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2057 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2058 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002059
2060 Example:
2061 capture response header Content-length len 9
2062 capture response header Location len 15
2063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002064 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002065 about logging.
2066
2067
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002068clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002069 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2071 yes | yes | yes | no
2072 Arguments :
2073 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2074 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2075 as explained at the top of this document.
2076
2077 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2078 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2079 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2080 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2081 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2082 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2083 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2084 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002085 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2087 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2088
2089 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2090 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2091 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2092 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2093 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2094 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2095
2096 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2097 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2098
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002099 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2100 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002101
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002102compression algo <algorithm> ...
2103compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002104compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002105 Enable HTTP compression.
2106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2107 yes | yes | yes | yes
2108 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002109 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2110 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2111 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2112
2113 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002114 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002115 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2116 data.
2117
2118 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2119 support for zlib was built in.
2120
2121 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2122 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2123 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2124 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2125 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2126 in.
2127
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002128 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002129 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002130 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2131 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2132 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2133 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2134 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002135
2136 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2137 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2138 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2139 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2140 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002141 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2142 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2143 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2144 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2145 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2146 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002147
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002148 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002149 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2150 "Accept-Encoding" header
2151 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002152 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002153 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2154 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002155 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2156 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2157 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2158 "multipart"
2159 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2160 header
2161 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2162 and later
2163 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2164 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002165
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002166 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2167 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002168
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002169 Examples :
2170 compression algo gzip
2171 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002172
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002173contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002174 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2176 yes | no | yes | yes
2177 Arguments :
2178 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2179 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2180 as explained at the top of this document.
2181
2182 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002183 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002184 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002185 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2186 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2187 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2188 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2189
2190 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2191 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2192 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2193 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2194 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2195 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2196
2197 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2198 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2199 instead.
2200
2201 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2202 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2203
2204
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002205cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002206 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2207 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002208 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2210 yes | no | yes | yes
2211 Arguments :
2212 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2213 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2214 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2215 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2216 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2217 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2218 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2219 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2220 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2221
2222 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2223 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2224 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2225 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2226 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2227 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2228 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2229 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2230 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2231 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2232 "insert" and "prefix".
2233
2234 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002235 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002236
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002237 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002238 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2239 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2240 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2241 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2242 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2243 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2244 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2245 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2246 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2247 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002248
2249 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2250 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2251 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2252 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2253 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2254 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2255 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2256 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2257 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2258 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002259 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2260 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2261 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002262
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002263 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2264 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2265 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002266 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2267 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2268 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2269 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002270 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2271 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2272 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002273
2274 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2275 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2276 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2277 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2278 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2279 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2280 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2281 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2282 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2283
2284 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2285 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2286 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2287 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2288 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2289 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2290 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2291 persistence cookie in the cache.
2292 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2293
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002294 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2295 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2296 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2297 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2298 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2299 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2300 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2301 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2302 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2303 they logout.
2304
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002305 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2306 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2307 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2308 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2309
2310 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2311 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2312 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2313 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2314 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2315 this attribute.
2316
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002317 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002318 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002319 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2320 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2321 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2322 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2323 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2324 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002325
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002326 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2327 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2328 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2329 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2330 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2331 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2332 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2333 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2334 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2335 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2336 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2337 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2338 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2339 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2340 the site.
2341
2342 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2343 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2344 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2345 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2346 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2347 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2348 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2349 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2350 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2351 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2352 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2353 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2354 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2355 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2356 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2357 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2358
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002359 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2360 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2361 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2362 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002364 Examples :
2365 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2366 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2367 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002368 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002370 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002371 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002372
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002374default-server [param*]
2375 Change default options for a server in a backend
2376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2377 yes | no | yes | yes
2378 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002379 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2380 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2381 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2382 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002383
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002384 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002385 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2386
2387 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002388
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002389
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390default_backend <backend>
2391 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2393 yes | yes | yes | no
2394 Arguments :
2395 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2396
2397 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2398 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2399 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2400 will catch all undetermined requests.
2401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002402 Example :
2403
2404 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2405 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2406 default_backend dynamic
2407
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002408 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002410
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002411description <string>
2412 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2414 no | yes | yes | yes
2415 Arguments : string
2416
2417 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2418 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2419 it describes.
2420 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2421
2422
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002423disabled
2424 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2426 yes | yes | yes | yes
2427 Arguments : none
2428
2429 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2430 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2431 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2432 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2433 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2434 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2435 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2436
2437 See also : "enabled"
2438
2439
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002440dispatch <address>:<port>
2441 Set a default server address
2442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2443 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002444 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002445
2446 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2447 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2448 during start-up.
2449
2450 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2451 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2452 possible with normal servers.
2453
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002454 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002455 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2456 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2457 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2458 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2459
2460 See also : "server"
2461
2462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002463enabled
2464 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2466 yes | yes | yes | yes
2467 Arguments : none
2468
2469 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2470 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2471
2472 See also : "disabled"
2473
2474
2475errorfile <code> <file>
2476 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2478 yes | yes | yes | yes
2479 Arguments :
2480 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002481 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002482
2483 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002484 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002485 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002486 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2487 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002488
2489 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2490 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2491 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2492
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002493 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2494
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2496 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2497 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2498 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2499
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002500 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2501 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2502 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2503 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2504 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2505 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2506
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002507 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2508 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2509 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002510 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002511 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2512
2513 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2514
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002515 Example :
2516 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002517 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002518 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2519 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2520
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002521
2522errorloc <code> <url>
2523errorloc302 <code> <url>
2524 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2526 yes | yes | yes | yes
2527 Arguments :
2528 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002529 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002530
2531 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2532 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2533 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2534 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2535 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2536
2537 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2538 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2539 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2540
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002541 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2542
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002543 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2544 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2545 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2546 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2547 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2548 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2549 request.
2550
2551 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2552
2553
2554errorloc303 <code> <url>
2555 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2557 yes | yes | yes | yes
2558 Arguments :
2559 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2560 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2561
2562 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2563 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2564 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2565 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2566 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2567
2568 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2569 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2570 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2571
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002572 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2573
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002574 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2575 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2576 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2577 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002578 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002579
2580 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2581
2582
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002583force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2584 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2585 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2586 no | yes | yes | yes
2587
2588 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2589 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2590 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2591 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2592 marked down for maintenance operations.
2593
2594 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2595 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2596 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2597 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2598 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2599 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2600 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2601 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2602 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2603
2604 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2605 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2606 is used.
2607
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002608 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002609 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002610
2611
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002612fullconn <conns>
2613 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2615 yes | no | yes | yes
2616 Arguments :
2617 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2618 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2619
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002620 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002621 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002622 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002623 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2624 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2625 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2626 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2627 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002628 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002629
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002630 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2631 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002632 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2633 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2634 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002635
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002636 Example :
2637 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2638 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2639 # connections.
2640 backend dynamic
2641 fullconn 10000
2642 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2643 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2644
2645 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2646
2647
2648grace <time>
2649 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002651 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002652 Arguments :
2653 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2654 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2655 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2656
2657 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2658 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002659 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002660 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2661
2662 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2663 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2664 simplify it.
2665
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002666
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002667hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002668 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2670 yes | no | yes | yes
2671 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002672 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2673 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002674
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002675 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2676 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2677 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2678 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2679 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2680 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2681 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2682 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2683 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2684 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002685
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002686 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2687 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2688 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2689 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2690 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2691 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2692 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2693 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2694 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2695 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2696 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2697 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2698 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002699 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2700 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002701
2702 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2703
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002704 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002705 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2706 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2707 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002708 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2709 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2710 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002711
2712 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2713 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002714 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2715 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2716 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2717 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2718
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002719 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2720 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2721 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2722 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2723 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2724 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2725 parameter.
2726
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002727 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2728
2729 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2730 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2731 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2732 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2733 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2734 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2735 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2736 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2737 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2738 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2739 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2740 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002741
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002742 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2743 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2744 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002745
2746 See also : "balance", "server"
2747
2748
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002749http-check disable-on-404
2750 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002752 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002753 Arguments : none
2754
2755 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2756 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2757 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2758 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2759 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2760 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2761 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2762 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002763 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2764 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2765 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2766
2767 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2768
2769
2770http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002771 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002773 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002774 Arguments :
2775 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2776 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002777 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002778 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2779 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2780 details on the supported keywords.
2781
2782 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2783 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2784 with the usual backslash ('\').
2785
2786 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2787 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2788 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2789 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2790 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2791
2792 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002793 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002794 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2795 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2796 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2797
2798 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002799 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002800 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2801 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2802 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2803 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2804
2805 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002806 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002807 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2808 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2809 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2810 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2811 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2812 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2813 trace).
2814
2815 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002816 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002817 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2818 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2819 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2820 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2821 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2822 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2823
2824 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2825 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2826 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2827 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2828 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2829 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2830 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2831 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2832
2833 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2834 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2835
2836 Examples :
2837 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002838 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002839
2840 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002841 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002842
2843 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002844 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002845
2846 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002847 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002848
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002849 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002850
2851
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002852http-check send-state
2853 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2855 yes | no | yes | yes
2856 Arguments : none
2857
2858 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2859 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2860 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2861 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2862 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2863
2864 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2865 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2866 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2867 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2868 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2869 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2870 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2871 checked in multiple backends.
2872
2873 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2874 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2875
2876 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2877 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2878 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2879 one fails.
2880
2881 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2882 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2883 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2884
2885 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2886 server's queue.
2887
2888 Example of a header received by the application server :
2889 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2890 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2891
2892 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2893
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002894http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002895 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002896 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002897 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2898 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002899 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2900 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2901 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2902 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2903 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2904 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002905 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002906 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2907
2908 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2909 no | yes | yes | yes
2910
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002911 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2912 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2913 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2914 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2915 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002916
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002917 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2918 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2919 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2920
2921 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2922 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2923 are evaluated.
2924
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002925 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2926 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2927 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2928 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2929 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2930 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2931 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2932 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2933 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002934 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002935 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2936
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002937 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2938 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2939 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2940 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2941 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2942
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002943 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2944 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2945 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002946 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2947 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002948
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002949 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2950 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2951 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2952 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2953 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2954 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2955 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2956 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2957
2958 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2959 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2960 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2961 external users.
2962
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002963 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2964 <name>.
2965
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002966 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
2967 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
2968 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
2969 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
2970 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
2971 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
2972 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
2973 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
2974
2975 Example:
2976
2977 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
2978
2979 applied to:
2980
2981 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
2982
2983 outputs:
2984
2985 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
2986
2987 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
2988
2989 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
2990 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
2991 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
2992 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
2993 header.
2994
2995 Example:
2996
2997 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
2998
2999 applied to:
3000
3001 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3002
3003 outputs:
3004
3005 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3006
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003007 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3008 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3009 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3010 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3011 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3012 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3013 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3014 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3015
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003016 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3017 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3018 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3019 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3020 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3021 another equipment.
3022
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003023 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3024 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3025 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3026 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3027 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3028 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3029 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3030 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3031
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003032 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3033 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3034 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3035 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3036 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3037 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3038 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3039 admin privileges.
3040
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003041 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3042 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3043 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3044 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3045 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3046 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3047 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3048 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3049
3050 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3051 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3052 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3053 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3054 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3055 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3056
3057 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3058 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3059 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3060 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3061 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3062 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3063
3064 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3065 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3066 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3067 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3068 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3069 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3070 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3071 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3072 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3073
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003074 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3075
3076 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3077 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3078 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3079 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003080
3081 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003082 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3083 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3084 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003085
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003086 http-request allow if nagios
3087 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3088 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3089 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003090
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003091 Example:
3092 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003093 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003094
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003095 Example:
3096 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3097 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3098 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3099 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3100 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3101 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3102 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3103 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3104 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3105
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003106 Example:
3107 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3108 acl add path /addacl
3109 acl del path /delacl
3110
3111 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3112
3113 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3114 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3115
3116 Example:
3117 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3118 acl setmap path /setmap
3119 acl delmap path /delmap
3120
3121 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3122
3123 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3124 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3125
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003126 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3127 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003128
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003129http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003130 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003131 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3132 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003133 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3134 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3135 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3136 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3137 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3138 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003139 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003140 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3141
3142 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3143 no | yes | yes | yes
3144
3145 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3146 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3147 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3148 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3149 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3150 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3151
3152 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3153 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3154 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3155 current section.
3156
3157 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3158 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3159 rules are evaluated.
3160
3161 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3162 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3163 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3164 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3165 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3166 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3167 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3168
3169 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3170 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3171 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3172 external users.
3173
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003174 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3175 <name>.
3176
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003177 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3178 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3179 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3180 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3181 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3182 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3183 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3184 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3185
3186 Example:
3187
3188 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3189
3190 applied to:
3191
3192 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3193
3194 outputs:
3195
3196 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3197
3198 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3199
3200 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3201 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3202 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3203 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3204 header.
3205
3206 Example:
3207
3208 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3209
3210 applied to:
3211
3212 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3213
3214 outputs:
3215
3216 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3217
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003218 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3219 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3220 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3221 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3222 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3223 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3224 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3225 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3226
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003227 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3228 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3229 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3230 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3231 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3232 another equipment.
3233
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003234 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3235 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3236 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3237 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3238 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3239 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3240 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3241 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3242
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003243 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3244 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3245 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3246 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3247 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3248 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3249 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3250 admin privileges.
3251
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003252 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3253 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3254 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3255 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3256 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3257 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3258 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3259 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3260
3261 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3262 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3263 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3264 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3265 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3266 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3267
3268 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3269 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3270 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3271 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3272 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3273 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3274
3275 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3276 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3277 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3278 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3279 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3280 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3281 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3282 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3283 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3284
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003285 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3286
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003287 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003288 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3289 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3290 rules.
3291
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003292 Example:
3293 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3294
3295 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3296
3297 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3298 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3299
3300 Example:
3301 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3302
3303 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3304
3305 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3306 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3307
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003308 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3309 ACL usage.
3310
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003311
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003312http-send-name-header [<header>]
3313 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3314
3315 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3316 yes | no | yes | yes
3317
3318 Arguments :
3319
3320 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3321
3322 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3323 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3324 is added with the header string proved.
3325
3326 See also : "server"
3327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003328id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003329 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3331 no | yes | yes | yes
3332 Arguments : none
3333
3334 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3335 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3336 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003337
3338
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003339ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3340 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3341 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3342 no | yes | yes | yes
3343
3344 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3345 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3346 and running).
3347
3348 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3349 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3350 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003351 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003352 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3353
3354 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3355 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3356
3357 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3358 "unless" condition is met.
3359
3360 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3361
3362
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003363log global
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003364log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003365no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003366 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3368 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003369
3370 Prefix :
3371 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3372 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3373 prefix does not allow arguments.
3374
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003375 Arguments :
3376 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3377 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3378 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3379 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3380 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3381 parameter.
3382
3383 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3384 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3385
3386 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3387 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3388 standard syslog port).
3389
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003390 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3391 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3392 standard syslog port).
3393
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003394 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3395 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3396 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3397 appropriately writeable).
3398
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003399 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3400 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3401 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3402 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3403
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003404 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3405 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3406 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3407 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3408 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3409 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3410 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3411 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3412 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3413 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3414 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3415
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003416 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3417
3418 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3419 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3420 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3421
3422 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3423 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3424 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003425 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3426 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3427 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3428 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3429 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003430
3431 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3432
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003433 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3434 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3435 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003436
3437 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3438 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3439 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3440 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3441
3442 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3443 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003444
3445 Example :
3446 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003447 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3448 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003449 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3450
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003451
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003452log-format <string>
3453 Allows you to custom a log line.
3454
3455 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3456
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003457
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003458max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3459 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3460 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3461 yes | no | yes | yes
3462
3463 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3464 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3465 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3466 servers.
3467
3468 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3469 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3470 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3471 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3472 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3473 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3474 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3475 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3476 picking a different server.
3477
3478 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3479 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3480 even if they have to be queued.
3481
3482 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3483 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3484
3485
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003486maxconn <conns>
3487 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3489 yes | yes | yes | no
3490 Arguments :
3491 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3492 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3493 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3494 closes.
3495
3496 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3497 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3498 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3499 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3500 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3501 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3502 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3503 properly tuned.
3504
3505 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3506 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3507 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3508
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003509 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3510
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003511 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3512
3513
3514mode { tcp|http|health }
3515 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3517 yes | yes | yes | yes
3518 Arguments :
3519 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3520 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3521 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3522 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3523
3524 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3525 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3526 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3527 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3528 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3529
3530 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003531 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3532 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3533 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3534 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3535 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3536 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3537 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003538
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003539 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3540 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3541 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003542
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003543 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003544 defaults http_instances
3545 mode http
3546
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003547 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003548
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003549
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003550monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003551 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3553 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003554 Arguments :
3555 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3556 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003557 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003558 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3559 backend and its backup.
3560
3561 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3562 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3563 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3564 servers in a list of backends.
3565
3566 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3567 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3568 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3569 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3570 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3571 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3572 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003573 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3574 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003575
3576 Example:
3577 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003578 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003579 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3580 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3581 monitor-uri /site_alive
3582 monitor fail if site_dead
3583
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003584 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003585
3586
3587monitor-net <source>
3588 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3590 yes | yes | yes | no
3591 Arguments :
3592 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3593 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3594 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3595 followed by a mask.
3596
3597 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3598 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003599 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003600 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3601
3602 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3603 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3604 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3605 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003606 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3607 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3608 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003609
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003610 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3611 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3612 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3613 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3614 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3615 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003616
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003617 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3618 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003619
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003620 Example :
3621 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3622 frontend www
3623 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3624
3625 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3626
3627
3628monitor-uri <uri>
3629 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3631 yes | yes | yes | no
3632 Arguments :
3633 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3634 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3635
3636 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3637 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3638 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3639 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3640 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3641 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3642 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3643 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3644
3645 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3646 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3647 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3648 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3649 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3650 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3651
3652 Example :
3653 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3654 frontend www
3655 mode http
3656 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3657
3658 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3659
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003660
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003661option abortonclose
3662no option abortonclose
3663 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3665 yes | no | yes | yes
3666 Arguments : none
3667
3668 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3669 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3670 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3671 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003672 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003673 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3674 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3675 encountered while delivering the response.
3676
3677 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3678 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3679 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3680 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3681 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3682 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003683 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003684 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003685 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003686 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3687 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3688 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3689
3690 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3691 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3692 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3693 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3694 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3695 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3696 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3697 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003698 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003699
3700 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3701 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3702
3703 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3704
3705
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003706option accept-invalid-http-request
3707no option accept-invalid-http-request
3708 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3710 yes | yes | yes | no
3711 Arguments : none
3712
3713 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3714 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3715 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3716 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3717 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3718 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3719 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3720 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003721 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3722 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3723 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3724 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3725 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3726 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003727
3728 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3729 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3730 been confirmed.
3731
3732 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3733 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003734 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3735 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003736 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3737
3738 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3739 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3740
3741 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3742 stats socket.
3743
3744
3745option accept-invalid-http-response
3746no option accept-invalid-http-response
3747 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3749 yes | no | yes | yes
3750 Arguments : none
3751
3752 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3753 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3754 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3755 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3756 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3757 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3758 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3759 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3760 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3761
3762 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3763 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3764 been confirmed.
3765
3766 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3767 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3768 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3769 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3770
3771 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3772 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3773
3774 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3775 stats socket.
3776
3777
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003778option allbackups
3779no option allbackups
3780 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3782 yes | no | yes | yes
3783 Arguments : none
3784
3785 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3786 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3787 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3788 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3789 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3790 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3791 order between the backup servers anymore.
3792
3793 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3794 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3795
3796 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3797 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3798
3799
3800option checkcache
3801no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003802 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3804 yes | no | yes | yes
3805 Arguments : none
3806
3807 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3808 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003809 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003810 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3811 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003812 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003813
3814 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003815 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003816 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003817 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3818 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003819 to the client are :
3820 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003821 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003822 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003823 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3824 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3825 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3826 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3827 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3828 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3829 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3830 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3831 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3832 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3833 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3834
3835 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003836 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003837 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003838 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003839 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3840
3841 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3842 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003843 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003844 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3845
3846 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3847 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3848
3849
3850option clitcpka
3851no option clitcpka
3852 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3854 yes | yes | yes | no
3855 Arguments : none
3856
3857 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3858 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3859 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3860 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3861
3862 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3863 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3864 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3865 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3866
3867 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3868 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3869 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3870 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3871 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3872
3873 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3874
3875 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3876 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3877 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3878
3879 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3880 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3881
3882 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3883
3884
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003885option contstats
3886 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3888 yes | yes | yes | no
3889 Arguments : none
3890
3891 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3892 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3893 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3894 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3895 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3896 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3897 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3898
3899
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003900option dontlog-normal
3901no option dontlog-normal
3902 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3904 yes | yes | yes | no
3905 Arguments : none
3906
3907 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3908 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3909 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3910 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3911 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3912 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3913 logged.
3914
3915 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3916 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3917 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003919 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003920 logging.
3921
3922
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003923option dontlognull
3924no option dontlognull
3925 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3927 yes | yes | yes | no
3928 Arguments : none
3929
3930 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3931 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3932 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3933 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3934 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3935 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3936 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3937
3938 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3939 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3940 would not be logged.
3941
3942 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3943 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003945 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003946
3947
3948option forceclose
3949no option forceclose
3950 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003952 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003953 Arguments : none
3954
3955 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3956 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3957 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3958 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3959 global session times in the logs.
3960
3961 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003962 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003963 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003964
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003965 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3966 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3967 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3968
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003969 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3970 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003971
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003972 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3973 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3974
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003975 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003976
3977
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003978option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003979 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3981 yes | yes | yes | yes
3982 Arguments :
3983 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3984 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003985 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003986 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003987
3988 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3989 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3990 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3991 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3992 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3993 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3994 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003995 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3996 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3997 possible that the client has already brought one.
3998
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003999 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004000 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004001 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4002 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004003 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4004 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004005
4006 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4007 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4008 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4009 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4010 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4011 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4012 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4013
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004014 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4015 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4016 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4017 are under the control of the end-user.
4018
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004019 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004020 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4021 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004022 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4023 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4024 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004025
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004026 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004027 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4028 frontend www
4029 mode http
4030 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4031
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004032 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4033 backend www
4034 mode http
4035 option forwardfor header X-Client
4036
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004037 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004038 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004039
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004040
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004041option http-keep-alive
4042no option http-keep-alive
4043 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4045 yes | yes | yes | yes
4046 Arguments : none
4047
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004048 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4049 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4050 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4051 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4052 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4053 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4054 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4055
4056 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4057 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004058 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4059 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4060 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4061 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4062 situations where this option may be useful :
4063
4064 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4065 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4066
4067 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4068 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4069
4070 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4071 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4072 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4073 request.
4074
4075 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4076 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004077 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4078 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4079 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004080
4081 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4082 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4083
4084 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4085 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4086 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4087 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4088 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4089 not set.
4090
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004091 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4092 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004093 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004094 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004095
4096 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004097 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4098 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004099
4100
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004101option http-no-delay
4102no option http-no-delay
4103 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4105 yes | yes | yes | yes
4106 Arguments : none
4107
4108 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4109 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4110 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4111 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4112 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4113 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4114 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4115 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4116 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4117 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4118 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4119 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4120 affected.
4121
4122 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4123 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4124 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4125 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4126 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4127 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4128 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4129 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4130 latency environments.
4131
4132
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004133option http-pretend-keepalive
4134no option http-pretend-keepalive
4135 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4137 yes | yes | yes | yes
4138 Arguments : none
4139
4140 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4141 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4142 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4143 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4144 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4145 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4146 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4147 consider the response complete.
4148
4149 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4150 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4151 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4152 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4153 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4154 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4155
4156 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4157 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4158 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4159 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4160 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4161 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4162 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4163
4164 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4165 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004166 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004167 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4168 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004169
4170 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4171 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4172
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004173 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4174 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004175
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004176
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004177option http-server-close
4178no option http-server-close
4179 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4181 yes | yes | yes | yes
4182 Arguments : none
4183
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004184 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4185 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4186 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4187 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4188 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4189 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4190 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4191 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4192 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4193 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4194 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4195 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4196 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4197 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4198 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4199 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004200
4201 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4202 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4203 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4204 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004205 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4206 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004207
4208 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4209 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004210 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4211 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004212 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4213 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004214
4215 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4216 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4217
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004218 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004219 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4220 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004221
4222
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004223option http-tunnel
4224no option http-tunnel
4225 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4227 yes | yes | yes | yes
4228 Arguments : none
4229
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004230 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4231 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4232 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4233 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4234 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4235 "option http-tunnel".
4236
4237 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004238 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004239 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4240 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4241 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4242 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4243 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4244 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4245 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004246
4247 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4248 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4249
4250 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4251 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4252 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4253
4254
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004255option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004256no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004257 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4259 yes | yes | yes | no
4260 Arguments : none
4261
4262 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4263 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4264 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4265 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4266 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4267 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4268 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4269
4270 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4271 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4272 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4273 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4274 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4275 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4276 request along its whole life.
4277
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004278 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4279 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4280 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4281 front of an existing proxy.
4282
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004283 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4284
4285 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4286 http-server-close".
4287
4288
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004289option httpchk
4290option httpchk <uri>
4291option httpchk <method> <uri>
4292option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4293 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4295 yes | no | yes | yes
4296 Arguments :
4297 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4298 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4299 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4300 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4301 ones.
4302
4303 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4304 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4305 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4306
4307 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4308 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4309 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4310 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4311 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4312
4313 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4314 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4315 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4316 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4317 the lack of any response.
4318
4319 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4320
4321 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4322 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4323 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4324
4325 Examples :
4326 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4327 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4328 backend https_relay
4329 mode tcp
4330 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4331 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4332
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004333 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4334 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4335 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004336
4337
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004338option httpclose
4339no option httpclose
4340 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4342 yes | yes | yes | yes
4343 Arguments : none
4344
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004345 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4346 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4347 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4348 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004349 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004350 "option http-tunnel".
4351
4352 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4353 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4354 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4355 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4356 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4357 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4358 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4359 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004360
4361 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004362 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004363 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4364 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4365 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4366 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4367 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004368
4369 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4370 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004371 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4372 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004373 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4374 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004375
4376 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4377 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4378
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004379 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4380 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004381
4382
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004383option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004384 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4386 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004387 Arguments :
4388 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4389 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4390 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4391 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4392 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004393
4394 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4395 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4396 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4397 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4398 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4399 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4400 ports.
4401
4402 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4403
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004404 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4405 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4406 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4407 by default.
4408
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004409 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004410
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004411
4412option http_proxy
4413no option http_proxy
4414 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4416 yes | yes | yes | yes
4417 Arguments : none
4418
4419 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4420 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4421 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4422 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4423 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4424
4425 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4426 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4427 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4428 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004429 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004430 be analyzed.
4431
4432 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4433 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4434
4435 Example :
4436 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4437 backend direct_forward
4438 option httpclose
4439 option http_proxy
4440
4441 See also : "option httpclose"
4442
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004443
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004444option independent-streams
4445no option independent-streams
4446 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4448 yes | yes | yes | yes
4449 Arguments : none
4450
4451 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4452 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4453 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4454 receive data or not.
4455
4456 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4457 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4458 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4459 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4460 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4461 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4462 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4463 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4464 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4465 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4466 socket buffers.
4467
4468 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4469 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4470 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4471 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4472 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4473
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004474 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004475 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4476 deprecated.
4477
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004478 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004479
4480
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004481option ldap-check
4482 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4484 yes | no | yes | yes
4485 Arguments : none
4486
4487 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4488 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4489 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4490 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4491
4492 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4493 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4494
4495 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4496 configure it.
4497
4498 Example :
4499 option ldap-check
4500
4501 See also : "option httpchk"
4502
4503
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004504option log-health-checks
4505no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004506 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4508 yes | no | yes | yes
4509 Arguments : none
4510
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004511 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4512 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4513 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004514
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004515 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4516 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4517 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4518 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4519 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4520
4521 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4522 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004523
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004524 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4525 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4526 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004527
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004528
4529option log-separate-errors
4530no option log-separate-errors
4531 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4533 yes | yes | yes | no
4534 Arguments : none
4535
4536 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4537 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4538 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4539 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4540 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4541 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4542 provides very important information.
4543
4544 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4545 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4546 error logs.
4547
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004548 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004549 logging.
4550
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004551
4552option logasap
4553no option logasap
4554 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4556 yes | yes | yes | no
4557 Arguments : none
4558
4559 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4560 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4561 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4562 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4563 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4564 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4565 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004566 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004567 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4568 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4569
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004570 Examples :
4571 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4572 mode http
4573 option httplog
4574 option logasap
4575 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4576
4577 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4578 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4579 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4580 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4581
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004582 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004583 logging.
4584
4585
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004586option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004587 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4589 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004590 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004591 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4592 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004593 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004594
4595 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4596 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4597 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4598 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4599 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4600 in the MySQL table, like this :
4601
4602 USE mysql;
4603 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4604 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4605
4606 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4607 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4608 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4609 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4610 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4611 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4612 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4613 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4614 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4615
4616 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4617 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004618
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004619 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004620
4621 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4622 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4623 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4624 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4625 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4626 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4627
4628 See also: "option httpchk"
4629
4630
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004631option nolinger
4632no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004633 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004634 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4635 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004636 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004637
4638 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4639 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4640 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4641 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4642 connections.
4643
4644 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4645 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4646 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4647 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4648 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4649 this too.
4650
4651 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4652 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4653 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4654
4655 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4656 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4657 for servers.
4658
4659 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4660 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4661
4662
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004663option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4664 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4666 yes | yes | yes | yes
4667 Arguments :
4668 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4669 matching <network>
4670 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4671 header name.
4672
4673 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4674 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4675 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4676 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4677 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4678 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4679 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4680 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4681 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4682 possible that the client has already brought one.
4683
4684 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4685 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4686 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4687 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4688 header and requires different one.
4689
4690 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4691 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4692 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4693 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4694 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4695 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4696 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4697
4698 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4699 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4700 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4701 both are defined.
4702
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004703 Examples :
4704 # Original Destination address
4705 frontend www
4706 mode http
4707 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4708
4709 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4710 backend www
4711 mode http
4712 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4713
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004714 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4715 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004716
4717
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004718option persist
4719no option persist
4720 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4721 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4722 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004723 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004724
4725 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4726 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4727 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4728 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4729 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4730 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4731 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4732 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4733 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4734 redirected to another valid server.
4735
4736 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4737 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4738
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004739 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004740
4741
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004742option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4743 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4745 yes | no | yes | yes
4746 Arguments :
4747 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4748 PostgreSQL server.
4749
4750 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4751 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4752 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4753 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4754
4755 See also: "option httpchk"
4756
4757
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004758option prefer-last-server
4759no option prefer-last-server
4760 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4761 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4762 yes | no | yes | yes
4763 Arguments : none
4764
4765 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4766 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4767 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4768 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4769 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4770 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4771 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4772 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4773 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004774 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4775 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4776 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4777 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4778 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4779 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4780 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004781
4782 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4783 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4784
4785 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4786
4787
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004788option redispatch
4789no option redispatch
4790 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4791 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4792 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004793 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004794
4795 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4796 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4797 be able to access the service anymore.
4798
4799 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4800 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4801
4802 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4803 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4804 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004805
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004806 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4807 "redisp" keywords.
4808
4809 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4810 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4811
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004812 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004813
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004814
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004815option redis-check
4816 Use redis health checks for server testing
4817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4818 yes | no | yes | yes
4819 Arguments : none
4820
4821 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4822 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4823 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4824 find the "+PONG" response message.
4825
4826 Example :
4827 option redis-check
4828
4829 See also : "option httpchk"
4830
4831
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004832option smtpchk
4833option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4834 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4836 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004837 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004838 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4839 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4840 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4841
4842 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4843 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4844 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4845
4846 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4847 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4848 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4849 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4850 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4851 dead server.
4852
4853 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4854 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4855 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4856 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4857
4858 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4859 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4860 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4861 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4862 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4863
4864 Example :
4865 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4866
4867 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4868
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004869
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004870option socket-stats
4871no option socket-stats
4872
4873 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4875 yes | yes | yes | no
4876
4877 Arguments : none
4878
4879
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004880option splice-auto
4881no option splice-auto
4882 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4884 yes | yes | yes | yes
4885 Arguments : none
4886
4887 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4888 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4889 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4890 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004891 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004892 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4893 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4894 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4895 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4896
4897 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4898 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4899 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4900 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4901 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4902 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4903 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4904 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4905 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4906 keyword.
4907
4908 Example :
4909 option splice-auto
4910
4911 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4912 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4913
4914 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4915 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4916
4917
4918option splice-request
4919no option splice-request
4920 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4922 yes | yes | yes | yes
4923 Arguments : none
4924
4925 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004926 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004927 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4928 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4929 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4930 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4931
4932 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4933
4934 Example :
4935 option splice-request
4936
4937 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4938 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4939
4940 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4941 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4942
4943
4944option splice-response
4945no option splice-response
4946 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4948 yes | yes | yes | yes
4949 Arguments : none
4950
4951 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004952 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004953 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4954 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4955 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4956 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4957
4958 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4959
4960 Example :
4961 option splice-response
4962
4963 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4964 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4965
4966 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4967 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4968
4969
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004970option srvtcpka
4971no option srvtcpka
4972 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4974 yes | no | yes | yes
4975 Arguments : none
4976
4977 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4978 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4979 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4980 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4981
4982 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4983 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4984 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4985 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4986
4987 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4988 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4989 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4990 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4991 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4992
4993 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4994
4995 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4996 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4997 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4998
4999 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5000 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5001
5002 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5003
5004
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005005option ssl-hello-chk
5006 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5008 yes | no | yes | yes
5009 Arguments : none
5010
5011 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5012 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5013 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5014 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5015 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5016 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5017 hello message.
5018
5019 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5020 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5021 messages, which is appreciable.
5022
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005023 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5024 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5025 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005026
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005027 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5028
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005029
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005030option tcp-check
5031 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5032 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5033 yes | no | yes | yes
5034
5035 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5036 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5037
5038 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5039 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5040 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5041
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005042 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005043 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5044 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5045 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5046 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5047 only.
5048
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005049 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005050 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5051 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5052 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5053 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5054
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005055 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005056 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5057 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005058 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005059 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5060 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5061 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5062 the respective protocols.
5063 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5064 analysed.
5065
5066 Examples :
5067 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5068 option tcp-check
5069 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5070
5071 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5072 option tcp-check
5073 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5074
5075 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5076 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005077 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005078 option tcp-check
5079 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5080 tcp-check expect +PONG
5081 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5082 tcp-check expect string role:master
5083 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5084 tcp-check expect string +OK
5085
5086 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5087 (send many headers before analyzing)
5088 option tcp-check
5089 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5090 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5091 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5092 tcp-check send \r\n
5093 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5094
5095
5096 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5097
5098
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005099option tcp-smart-accept
5100no option tcp-smart-accept
5101 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5103 yes | yes | yes | no
5104 Arguments : none
5105
5106 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5107 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5108 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5109 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5110 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5111 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5112
5113 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5114 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5115 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5116 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5117
5118 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5119 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5120 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5121 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5122
5123 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5124 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5125 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5126
5127 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5128 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5129 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5130
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005131 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5132
5133
5134option tcp-smart-connect
5135no option tcp-smart-connect
5136 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5138 yes | no | yes | yes
5139 Arguments : none
5140
5141 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5142 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5143 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5144 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5145 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5146
5147 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5148 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5149 complex.
5150
5151 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5152 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5153 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5154
5155 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5156 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5157
5158 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5159
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005160
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005161option tcpka
5162 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5164 yes | yes | yes | yes
5165 Arguments : none
5166
5167 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5168 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5169 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5170 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5171
5172 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5173 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5174 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5175 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5176
5177 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5178 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5179 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5180 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5181 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5182
5183 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5184
5185 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5186 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5187 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5188 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5189 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5190 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5191 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5192 backends.
5193
5194 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5195
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005196
5197option tcplog
5198 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5200 yes | yes | yes | yes
5201 Arguments : none
5202
5203 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5204 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5205 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5206 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5207 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5208 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5209 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5210 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5211
5212 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005214 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005215
5216
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005217option transparent
5218no option transparent
5219 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005221 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005222 Arguments : none
5223
5224 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5225 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5226 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5227 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5228 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5229 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5230 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5231 appropriate server.
5232
5233 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5234 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5235
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005236 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005237 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005238
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005239
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005240persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005241persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005242 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5244 yes | no | yes | yes
5245 Arguments :
5246 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005247 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5248 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005249
5250 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5251 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5252 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5253 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5254 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5255 forwarded to this server.
5256
5257 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5258 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5259 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005260 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005261 a single "listen" section.
5262
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005263 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5264 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5265 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5266
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005267 Example :
5268 listen tse-farm
5269 bind :3389
5270 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5271 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5272 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5273 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5274 persist rdp-cookie
5275 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005276 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005277 balance rdp-cookie
5278 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5279 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5280
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005281 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5282 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005283
5284
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005285rate-limit sessions <rate>
5286 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5288 yes | yes | yes | no
5289 Arguments :
5290 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5291 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5292
5293 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5294 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5295 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5296 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5297 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5298 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5299
5300 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5301 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5302 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5303 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5304
5305 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5306 listen smtp
5307 mode tcp
5308 bind :25
5309 rate-limit sessions 10
5310 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5311
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005312 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5313 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5314 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005315
5316 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5317
5318
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005319redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5320redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5321redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005322 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5324 no | yes | yes | yes
5325
5326 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005327 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005328
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005329 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005330 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005331 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5332 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5333 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005334
5335 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5336 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5337 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5338 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5339 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005340 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5341 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5342 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5343 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005344
5345 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5346 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5347 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5348 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5349 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5350 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005351 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005352 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005353 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5354 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5355 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005356
5357 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005358 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5359 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5360 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5361 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5362 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5363 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5364 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5365 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005366
5367 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5368 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5369
5370 - "drop-query"
5371 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5372 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5373 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5374 with a location-type redirect.
5375
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005376 - "append-slash"
5377 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5378 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5379 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5380 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5381
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005382 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5383 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5384 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5385 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5386 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5387 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5388 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5389
5390 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5391 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5392 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5393 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5394 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5395 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5396 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005397
5398 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5399 acl clear dst_port 80
5400 acl secure dst_port 8080
5401 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005402 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005403 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005404 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5405
5406 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005407 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5408 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5409 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005410 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005411
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005412 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5413 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5414 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5415
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005416 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005417 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005418
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005419 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5420 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5421 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005423 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005424
5425
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005426redisp (deprecated)
5427redispatch (deprecated)
5428 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5429 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5430 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005431 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005432
5433 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5434 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5435 be able to access the service anymore.
5436
5437 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5438 redistribute them to a working server.
5439
5440 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5441 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5442 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005444 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5445 "option redispatch" instead.
5446
5447 See also : "option redispatch"
5448
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005449
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005450reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005451 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5453 no | yes | yes | yes
5454 Arguments :
5455 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5456 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005457 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005458
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005459 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5460 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5461
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005462 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5463 the last header of an HTTP request.
5464
5465 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5466 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5467 responses.
5468
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005469 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5470 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5471 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5472
5473 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5474 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005475
5476
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005477reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5478reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005479 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5481 no | yes | yes | yes
5482 Arguments :
5483 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5484 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5485 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5486 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5487 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5488 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5489 ignores case.
5490
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005491 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5492 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5493
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005494 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5495 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5496 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5497 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005498 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005499
5500 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5501 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5502
5503 Example :
5504 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5505 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5506 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5507
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005508 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5509 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005510
5511
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005512reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5513reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005514 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5516 no | yes | yes | yes
5517 Arguments :
5518 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5519 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5520 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5521 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5522 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5523 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5524
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005525 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5526 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5527
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005528 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5529 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5530 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5531 next servers.
5532
5533 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5534 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5535 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5536
5537 Example :
5538 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5539 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5540 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5541
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005542 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5543 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005544
5545
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005546reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5547reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005548 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5550 no | yes | yes | yes
5551 Arguments :
5552 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5553 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5554 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5555 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5556 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5557 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5558 case.
5559
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005560 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5561 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5562
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005563 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5564 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5565 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5566 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005567 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005568
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005569 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005570 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005571 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005572
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005573 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5574 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5575
5576 Example :
5577 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5578 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5579 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5580
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005581 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5582 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005583
5584
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005585reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5586reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005587 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5589 no | yes | yes | yes
5590 Arguments :
5591 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5592 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5593 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5594 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5595 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5596 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5597 case.
5598
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005599 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5600 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5601
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005602 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5603 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5604 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5605 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5606
5607 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5608 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5609
5610 Example :
5611 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5612 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5613 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5614 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5615
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005616 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5617 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005618
5619
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005620reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5621reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005622 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5624 no | yes | yes | yes
5625 Arguments :
5626 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5627 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5628 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5629 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5630 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5631 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5632
5633 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5634 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5635 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5636 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005637 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005638
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005639 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5640 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5641
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005642 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5643 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5644 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5645
5646 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5647 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5648 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5649 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5650 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5651
5652 Example :
5653 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005654 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005655 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5656 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5657
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005658 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5659 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005660
5661
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005662reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5663reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005664 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5666 no | yes | yes | yes
5667 Arguments :
5668 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5669 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5670 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5671 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5672 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5673 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5674 ignores case.
5675
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005676 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5677 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5678
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005679 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5680 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005681 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5682 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5683 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005684 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5685 not set.
5686
5687 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5688 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5689 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5690 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5691 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5692
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005693 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005694 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5695 # block all others.
5696 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5697 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5698
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005699 # block bad guys
5700 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5701 reqitarpit . if badguys
5702
5703 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5704 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005705
5706
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005707retries <value>
5708 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5709 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5710 yes | no | yes | yes
5711 Arguments :
5712 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5713 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5714 default value is 3.
5715
5716 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5717 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5718 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5719
5720 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5721 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5722
5723 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5724 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5725
5726 See also : "option redispatch"
5727
5728
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005729rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005730 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5732 no | yes | yes | yes
5733 Arguments :
5734 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5735 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005736 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005737
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005738 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5739 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5740
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005741 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5742 the last header of an HTTP response.
5743
5744 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5745 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5746 responses.
5747
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005748 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5749 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005750
5751
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005752rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5753rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005754 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5756 no | yes | yes | yes
5757 Arguments :
5758 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5759 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5760 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5761 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5762 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5763 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5764 ignores case.
5765
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005766 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5767 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5768
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005769 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5770 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005771 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005772 client.
5773
5774 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5775 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5776 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5777
5778 Example :
5779 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005780 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005781
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005782 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5783 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005784
5785
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005786rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5787rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005788 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5790 no | yes | yes | yes
5791 Arguments :
5792 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5793 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5794 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5795 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5796 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5797 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5798 ignores case.
5799
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005800 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5801 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5802
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005803 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5804 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5805 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5806 case-sensitive.
5807
5808 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005809 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5810 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5811 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005812
5813 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5814 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5815
5816 Example :
5817 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5818 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5819
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005820 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5821 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005822
5823
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005824rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5825rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005826 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5828 no | yes | yes | yes
5829 Arguments :
5830 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5831 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5832 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5833 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5834 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5835 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5836 ignores case.
5837
5838 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5839 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5840 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5841 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005842 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005843
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005844 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5845 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5846
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005847 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5848 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5849 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5850
5851 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5852 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5853 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5854 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5855 are not case-sensitive.
5856
5857 Example :
5858 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5859 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5860
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005861 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5862 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005863
5864
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005865server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005866 Declare a server in a backend
5867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5868 no | no | yes | yes
5869 Arguments :
5870 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005871 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005872 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005873
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005874 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5875 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5876 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5877 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005878 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5879 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5880 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5881 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5882 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005883 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5884 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5885 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5886 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5887 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5888 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5889 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005890 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005891 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5892 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5893 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5894 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005895
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005896 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005897 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5898 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5899 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5900 adding this value to the client's port.
5901
5902 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5903 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005904 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005905
5906 Examples :
5907 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5908 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005909 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005910 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5911 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5912 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005913
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005914 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5915 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005916
5917
5918source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005919source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005920source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005921 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5923 yes | no | yes | yes
5924 Arguments :
5925 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5926 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005927
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005928 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005929 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5930 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5931 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5932 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5933 supported prefixes are :
5934 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5935 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5936 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005937 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005938 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5939 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5940 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5941 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005942
5943 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5944 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005945 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5946 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5947 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005948
5949 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5950 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5951 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5952 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5953 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5954 <addr>.
5955
5956 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5957 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5958 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5959 port.
5960
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005961 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5962 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5963 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5964 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005965 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005966 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5967 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5968 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5969 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5970 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5971 HTTP header.
5972
5973 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5974 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005975 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005976 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5977 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5978 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5979 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5980 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5981 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5982 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5983
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005984 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5985 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5986 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5987 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5988 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5989 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5990
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005991 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5992 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5993 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5994 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5995
5996 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5997 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5998 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5999 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6000 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6001 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6002
6003 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6004 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6005 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6006 there are two methods :
6007
6008 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6009 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6010 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6011 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6012 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6013 of the client ranges may be used.
6014
6015 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6016 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6017 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6018 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6019 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6020 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6021 same session.
6022
6023 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6024 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6025 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6026 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6027 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6028 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6029
6030 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6031 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6032 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006033 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006034
6035 Examples :
6036 backend private
6037 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6038 source 192.168.1.200
6039
6040 backend transparent_ssl1
6041 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6042 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6043
6044 backend transparent_ssl2
6045 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6046 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6047 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6048
6049 backend transparent_ssl3
6050 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6051 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6052 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6053
6054 backend transparent_smtp
6055 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6056 # with Tproxy version 4.
6057 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6058
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006059 backend transparent_http
6060 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6061 # proxy.
6062 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006064 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006065 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006067
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006068srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6069 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6071 yes | no | yes | yes
6072 Arguments :
6073 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6074 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6075 as explained at the top of this document.
6076
6077 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6078 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6079 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6080 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6081 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6082 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6083 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6084
6085 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6086 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6087 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6088 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6089 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006090 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006091 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006092 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006093
6094 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6095 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6096 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6097 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6098 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6099 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6100
6101 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6102 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6103
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006104 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6105 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006106
6107
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006108stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6109 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006111 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006112
6113 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6114 matched.
6115
6116 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6117 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6118
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006119 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6120 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6121 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6122
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006123 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6124 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6125 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6126 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006127
6128 Example :
6129 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6130 backend stats_localhost
6131 stats enable
6132 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6133
6134 Example :
6135 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6136 backend stats_auth
6137 stats enable
6138 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6139 stats admin if TRUE
6140
6141 Example :
6142 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6143 userlist stats-auth
6144 group admin users admin
6145 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6146 group readonly users haproxy
6147 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6148
6149 backend stats_auth
6150 stats enable
6151 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6152 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6153 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6154 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6155
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006156 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6157 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6158 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006159
6160
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006161stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6162 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006164 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006165 Arguments :
6166 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6167
6168 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6169
6170 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6171 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6172 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6173 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6174 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6175 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6176
6177 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6178 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6179 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006180 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006181
6182 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6183 report using "stats scope".
6184
6185 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6186 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6187 unobvious parameters.
6188
6189 Example :
6190 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6191 backend public_www
6192 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6193 stats enable
6194 stats hide-version
6195 stats scope .
6196 stats uri /admin?stats
6197 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6198 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6199 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6200
6201 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6202 backend private_monitoring
6203 stats enable
6204 stats uri /admin?stats
6205 stats refresh 5s
6206
6207 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6208
6209
6210stats enable
6211 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006213 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006214 Arguments : none
6215
6216 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6217 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6218 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6219 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6220 - stats auth : no authentication
6221 - stats scope : no restriction
6222
6223 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6224 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6225 unobvious parameters.
6226
6227 Example :
6228 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6229 backend public_www
6230 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6231 stats enable
6232 stats hide-version
6233 stats scope .
6234 stats uri /admin?stats
6235 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6236 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6237 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6238
6239 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6240 backend private_monitoring
6241 stats enable
6242 stats uri /admin?stats
6243 stats refresh 5s
6244
6245 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6246
6247
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006248stats hide-version
6249 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006251 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006252 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006253
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006254 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6255 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6256 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6257 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6258 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6259 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006260
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006261 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6262 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6263 unobvious parameters.
6264
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006265 Example :
6266 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6267 backend public_www
6268 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006269 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006270 stats hide-version
6271 stats scope .
6272 stats uri /admin?stats
6273 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6274 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6275 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006276
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006277 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6278 backend private_monitoring
6279 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006280 stats uri /admin?stats
6281 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006282
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006283 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006284
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006285
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006286stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6287 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6288 Access control for statistics
6289
6290 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6291 no | no | yes | yes
6292
6293 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6294 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6295 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6296 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6297 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6298 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6299
6300 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6301 instance.
6302
6303 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6304 about ACL usage.
6305
6306
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006307stats realm <realm>
6308 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006310 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006311 Arguments :
6312 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6313 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6314 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6315
6316 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6317 using a backslash ('\').
6318
6319 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6320 only related to authentication.
6321
6322 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6323 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6324 unobvious parameters.
6325
6326 Example :
6327 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6328 backend public_www
6329 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6330 stats enable
6331 stats hide-version
6332 stats scope .
6333 stats uri /admin?stats
6334 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6335 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6336 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6337
6338 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6339 backend private_monitoring
6340 stats enable
6341 stats uri /admin?stats
6342 stats refresh 5s
6343
6344 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6345
6346
6347stats refresh <delay>
6348 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006350 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006351 Arguments :
6352 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6353 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6354 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6355 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6356 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6357 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6358
6359 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6360 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6361 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6362 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6363
6364 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6365 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6366 unobvious parameters.
6367
6368 Example :
6369 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6370 backend public_www
6371 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6372 stats enable
6373 stats hide-version
6374 stats scope .
6375 stats uri /admin?stats
6376 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6377 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6378 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6379
6380 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6381 backend private_monitoring
6382 stats enable
6383 stats uri /admin?stats
6384 stats refresh 5s
6385
6386 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6387
6388
6389stats scope { <name> | "." }
6390 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006392 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006393 Arguments :
6394 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6395 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6396 section in which the statement appears.
6397
6398 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6399 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6400 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6401 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6402 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6403 exists.
6404
6405 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6406 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6407 unobvious parameters.
6408
6409 Example :
6410 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6411 backend public_www
6412 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6413 stats enable
6414 stats hide-version
6415 stats scope .
6416 stats uri /admin?stats
6417 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6418 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6419 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6420
6421 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6422 backend private_monitoring
6423 stats enable
6424 stats uri /admin?stats
6425 stats refresh 5s
6426
6427 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6428
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006429
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006430stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006431 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006433 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006434
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006435 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006436 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6437
6438 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6439 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6440
6441 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6442 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006443 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006444
6445 Example :
6446 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6447 backend private_monitoring
6448 stats enable
6449 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6450 stats uri /admin?stats
6451 stats refresh 5s
6452
6453 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6454 global section.
6455
6456
6457stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006458 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6460 yes | yes | yes | yes
6461 Arguments : none
6462
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006463 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006464 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6465 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6466 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6467 - IP (socket, server)
6468 - cookie (backend, server)
6469
6470 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6471 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006472 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006473
6474 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6475
6476
6477stats show-node [ <name> ]
6478 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006480 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006481 Arguments:
6482 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6483 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6484
6485 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6486 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006487 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006488
6489 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6490 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6491 unobvious parameters.
6492
6493 Example:
6494 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6495 backend private_monitoring
6496 stats enable
6497 stats show-node Europe-1
6498 stats uri /admin?stats
6499 stats refresh 5s
6500
6501 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6502 section.
6503
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006504
6505stats uri <prefix>
6506 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006508 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006509 Arguments :
6510 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6511 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6512 query string.
6513
6514 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6515 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6516 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6517 possible to reach it in the application.
6518
6519 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006520 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006521 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6522 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6523 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6524 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6525
6526 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6527 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6528 an address or a port to statistics only.
6529
6530 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6531 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6532 unobvious parameters.
6533
6534 Example :
6535 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6536 backend public_www
6537 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6538 stats enable
6539 stats hide-version
6540 stats scope .
6541 stats uri /admin?stats
6542 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6543 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6544 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6545
6546 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6547 backend private_monitoring
6548 stats enable
6549 stats uri /admin?stats
6550 stats refresh 5s
6551
6552 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6553
6554
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006555stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6556 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006558 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006559
6560 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006561 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006562 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6563 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6564 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6565
6566 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6567 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6568 the "stick-table" statement.
6569
6570 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6571 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6572 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6573 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6574 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6575
6576 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6577 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6578 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6579 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6580 transformation rules.
6581
6582 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6583 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6584 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6585 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6586 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6587 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6588 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6589
6590 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6591 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6592 ACL based conditions.
6593
6594 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6595 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6596 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6597 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6598
6599 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6600 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6601 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6602 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6603
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006604 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6605 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6606 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6607
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006608 Example :
6609 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6610 # last 30 minutes
6611 backend pop
6612 mode tcp
6613 balance roundrobin
6614 stick store-request src
6615 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6616 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6617 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6618
6619 backend smtp
6620 mode tcp
6621 balance roundrobin
6622 stick match src table pop
6623 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6624 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6625
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006626 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006627 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006628
6629
6630stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6631 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6633 no | no | yes | yes
6634
6635 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6636 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6637 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6638 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6639
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006640 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6641 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6642 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6643
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006644 Examples :
6645 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006646 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006647
6648 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6649 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6650 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6651
6652
6653 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6654 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6655 backend http
6656 mode http
6657 balance roundrobin
6658 stick on src table https
6659 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6660 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6661 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6662
6663 backend https
6664 mode tcp
6665 balance roundrobin
6666 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6667 stick on src
6668 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6669 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6670
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006671 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006672
6673
6674stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6675 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6677 no | no | yes | yes
6678
6679 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006680 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006681 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6682 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6683 server is selected.
6684
6685 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6686 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6687 the "stick-table" statement.
6688
6689 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6690 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6691 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6692 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6693 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6694 address.
6695
6696 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6697 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6698 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6699 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6700 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6701 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6702 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6703 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6704 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6705 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6706
6707 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6708 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6709 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6710 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6711 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6712 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6713 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6714
6715 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6716 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6717 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6718 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6719
6720 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6721 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6722 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6723 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6724 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6725 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006726 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6727 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6728 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6729 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6730 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6731 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006732
6733 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6734 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6735 the request.
6736
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006737 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6738 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6739 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6740
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006741 Example :
6742 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6743 # last 30 minutes
6744 backend pop
6745 mode tcp
6746 balance roundrobin
6747 stick store-request src
6748 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6749 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6750 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6751
6752 backend smtp
6753 mode tcp
6754 balance roundrobin
6755 stick match src table pop
6756 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6757 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6758
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006759 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006760 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006761
6762
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006763stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006764 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6765 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006766 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006768 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006769
6770 Arguments :
6771 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6772 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6773 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6774 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6775
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006776 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6777 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6778 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6779 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6780
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006781 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6782 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6783 instance.
6784
6785 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6786 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6787 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6788 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6789 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6790 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006791 to 32 characters.
6792
6793 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6794 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6795 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006796 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006797 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6798 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006799
6800 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006801 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6802 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006803 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6804 increase.
6805
6806 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006807 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6808 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6809 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006810
6811 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6812 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6813 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6814 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6815 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6816 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6817 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6818 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6819 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6820 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6821 parameter (see below).
6822
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006823 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6824 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6825 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6826 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6827 soft restart.
6828
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006829 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6830
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006831 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6832 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6833 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6834 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6835 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006836 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006837 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6838 if not expiration delay is specified.
6839
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006840 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6841 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6842 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6843 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006844 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6845 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6846 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6847 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6848 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6849 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6850 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6851 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6852 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6853 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6854 types and their arguments.
6855
6856 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6857 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6858 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6859 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6860
6861 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6862 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6863 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6864 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6865
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006866 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6867 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6868 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6869 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6870 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6871 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6872
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006873 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6874 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6875 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6876 they were received.
6877
6878 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6879 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6880 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6881 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6882 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6883
6884 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6885 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6886 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6887 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6888 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6889
6890 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6891 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6892 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6893
6894 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6895 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6896 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6897 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6898 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6899
6900 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6901 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6902 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6903 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6904 the client side.
6905
6906 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6907 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6908 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6909 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6910 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6911 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6912 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6913
6914 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6915 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6916 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6917 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6918 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6919 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6920 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6921
6922 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6923 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6924 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6925 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6926 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6927 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6928
6929 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6930 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6931 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6932 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6933
6934 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6935 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6936 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6937 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6938 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6939 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6940 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6941 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6942 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6943 recommended for better fairness.
6944
6945 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6946 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6947 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6948 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6949
6950 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6951 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6952 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6953 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6954 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6955 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6956 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6957 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6958 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6959 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006960
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006961 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6962 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006963 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6964 reference it.
6965
6966 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6967 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6968 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6969 as an exclusive stickiness.
6970
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006971 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6972 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6973 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6974 something that can be ignored.
6975
6976 Example:
6977 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6978 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6979 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6980 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6981
6982 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006983 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006984
6985
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006986stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6987 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6989 no | no | yes | yes
6990
6991 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006992 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006993 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6994 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6995 server is selected.
6996
6997 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6998 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6999 the "stick-table" statement.
7000
7001 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7002 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7003 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7004 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7005
7006 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7007 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7008 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7009 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7010 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7011 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007012 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007013 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7014 rules.
7015
7016 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7017 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7018 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7019 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7020 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7021 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7022 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7023
7024 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7025 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7026 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7027 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7028
7029 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7030 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7031 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7032 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7033 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7034 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007035 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7036 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7037 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7038 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7039 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7040 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7041 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7042 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7043 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007044
7045 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7046
7047 Example :
7048 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7049 backend https
7050 mode tcp
7051 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007052 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007053 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007054
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007055 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7056 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7057
7058 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7059 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7060 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7061
7062 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7063 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007064
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007065 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7066 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7067 # at offset 44.
7068
7069 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7070 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7071
7072 # Learn on response if server hello.
7073 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007074
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007075 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7076 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7077
7078 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7079 extraction.
7080
7081
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007082tcp-check connect [params*]
7083 Opens a new connection
7084 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7085 no | no | yes | yes
7086
7087 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7088 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7089 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7090
7091 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7092 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7093 of the sequence.
7094
7095 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7096 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7097 do.
7098
7099 Parameters :
7100 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7101 use the TCP connection.
7102
7103 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7104 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7105 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7106
7107 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7108
7109 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7110
7111 Examples:
7112 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7113 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7114 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7115 option tcp-check
7116 tcp-check connect
7117 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7118 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7119 tcp-check send \r\n
7120 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7121 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7122 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7123 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7124 tcp-check send \r\n
7125 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7126 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7127
7128 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7129 option tcp-check
7130 tcp-check connect port 110
7131 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7132 tcp-check connect port 143
7133 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7134 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7135
7136 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7137
7138
7139tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7140 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7141 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7142 no | no | yes | yes
7143
7144 Arguments :
7145 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7146 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7147 binary.
7148 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7149 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7150 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7151
7152 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7153 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7154 with the usual backslash ('\').
7155 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7156 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7157 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7158 used upper or lower case.
7159
7160
7161 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7162
7163 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7164 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7165 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7166 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7167 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7168 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7169 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7170 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7171
7172 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7173 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7174 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7175 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7176 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7177 expression.
7178
7179 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7180 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7181 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7182 this exact hexadecimal string.
7183 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7184
7185 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7186 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7187 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7188 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7189 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7190 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7191 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7192 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7193 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7194 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7195 the null character.
7196
7197 Examples :
7198 # perform a POP check
7199 option tcp-check
7200 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7201
7202 # perform an IMAP check
7203 option tcp-check
7204 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7205
7206 # look for the redis master server
7207 option tcp-check
7208 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7209 tcp-check expect +PONG
7210 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7211 tcp-check expect string role:master
7212 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7213 tcp-check expect string +OK
7214
7215
7216 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7217 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7218
7219
7220tcp-check send <data>
7221 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7222 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7223 no | no | yes | yes
7224
7225 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7226 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7227
7228 Examples :
7229 # look for the redis master server
7230 option tcp-check
7231 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7232 tcp-check expect string role:master
7233
7234 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7235 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7236
7237
7238tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7239 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7240 tcp health check
7241 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7242 no | no | yes | yes
7243
7244 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7245 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7246 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7247 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7248 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7249 hexadecimal string.
7250 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7251
7252 Examples :
7253 # redis check in binary
7254 option tcp-check
7255 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7256 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7257
7258
7259 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7260 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7261
7262
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007263tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7264 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7266 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007267 Arguments :
7268 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007269 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7270 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007271
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007272 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007273
7274 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7275 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007276 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7277 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7278 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7279 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7280 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7281 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007282
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007283 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7284 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7285 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7286 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007287
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007288 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007289 - accept :
7290 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7291 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7292 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007293
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007294 - reject :
7295 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7296 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7297 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7298 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7299 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7300 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7301 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7302 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7303 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7304 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7305 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7306 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007307
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007308 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7309 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7310 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7311 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7312 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7313 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7314 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7315 hosts.
7316
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007317 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7318 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7319 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7320 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7321 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7322 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7323 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7324 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7325 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7326 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7327 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7328
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007329 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007330 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7331 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7332 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007333 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7334 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007335 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007336 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7337 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7338 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7339 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7340 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007341
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007342 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007343 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007344 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007345 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7346 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7347 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7348 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007349
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007350 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7351 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7352 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7353 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007354
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007355 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7356 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7357 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7358 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7359 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007360 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7361 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7362 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7363 layer7 information is extracted.
7364
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007365 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7366 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7367 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7368 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7369 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007370
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007371 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7372 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7373 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007374
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007375 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7376 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7377 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007378
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007379 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007380 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007381 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007382
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007383 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7384 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7385 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007386
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007387 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007388 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7389 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007390
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007391 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7392
7393 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7394
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007395 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7396
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007397 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007398
7399
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007400tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7401 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007403 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007404 Arguments :
7405 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007406 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007407 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7408 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007409
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007410 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007411
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007412 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7413 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7414 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7415 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7416 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007417
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007418 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7419 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7420 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7421 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007422 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7423 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7424 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7425 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7426 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7427 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007428 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007429 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007430
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007431 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7432 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7433 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7434 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007435
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007436 Four types of actions are supported :
7437 - accept : the request is accepted
7438 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7439 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007440 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007441
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007442 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7443 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007444
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007445 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7446 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7447 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7448 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7449 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7450 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007451
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007452 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007453 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7454 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007455
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007456 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007457 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7458 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7459 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7460 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007461 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7462 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7463 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007464
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007465 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7466 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7467 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7468 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7469
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007470 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007471 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7472 # and reject everything else.
7473 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7474 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007475 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007476 tcp-request content reject
7477
7478 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007479 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7480 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7481 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007482 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007483
7484 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7485 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7486 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007487 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007488 tcp-request content reject
7489
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007490 Example:
7491 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7492 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007493 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007494
7495 Example:
7496 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7497 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007498 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007499
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007500 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7501 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7502
7503 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007504 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007505 # protecting all our sites
7506 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007507 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7508 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007509 ...
7510 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7511
7512 backend http_dynamic
7513 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007514 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007515 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007516 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7517 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7518 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007519 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007520
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007521 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007522
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007523 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007524
7525
7526tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7527 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007529 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007530 Arguments :
7531 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7532 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7533 as explained at the top of this document.
7534
7535 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7536 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7537 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7538 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7539 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7540
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007541 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7542 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7543 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7544 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7545
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007546 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7547 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007548 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007549 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007550 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7551 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7552 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7553 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007554
7555 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7556 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7557 it pass through unaffected.
7558
7559 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7560 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7561 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007562 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007563 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7564 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007565 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7566 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7567 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007568
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007569 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007570 "timeout client".
7571
7572
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007573tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7574 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7576 no | no | yes | yes
7577 Arguments :
7578 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007579 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007580
7581 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7582
7583 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7584 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7585 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007586 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7587 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007588
7589 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7590
7591 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7592 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7593 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7594 inserted.
7595
7596 Two types of actions are supported :
7597 - accept :
7598 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7599 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7600 the rules evaluation.
7601
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007602 - close :
7603 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7604 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7605 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7606 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7607 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7608 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007609 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007610 protocols.
7611
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007612 - reject :
7613 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7614 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007615 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007616
7617 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7618 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7619 for changing the default action to a reject.
7620
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007621 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7622 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7623 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7624 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007625 period.
7626
7627 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7628
7629 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7630
7631
7632tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7633 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7635 no | no | yes | yes
7636 Arguments :
7637 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7638 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7639 as explained at the top of this document.
7640
7641 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7642
7643
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007644timeout check <timeout>
7645 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7646 established.
7647
7648 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7649 yes | no | yes | yes
7650 Arguments:
7651 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7652 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7653 as explained at the top of this document.
7654
7655 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7656 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7657 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7658 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007659 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7660 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7661 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007662
7663 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7664 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7665
7666 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7667 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007668 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007669
7670 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7671 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7672 forget about it.
7673
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007674 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7675 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007676
7677
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007678timeout client <timeout>
7679timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7680 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7682 yes | yes | yes | no
7683 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007684 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007685 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7686 as explained at the top of this document.
7687
7688 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7689 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7690 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7691 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7692 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7693 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7694 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7695 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007696 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007697 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007698 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7699 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007700 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7701 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007702
7703 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7704 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7705 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7706 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7707 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7708 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7709
7710 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7711 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7712 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7713
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007714 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007715
7716
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007717timeout client-fin <timeout>
7718 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7720 yes | yes | yes | no
7721 Arguments :
7722 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7723 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7724 as explained at the top of this document.
7725
7726 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7727 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7728 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7729 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7730 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7731 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7732 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7733 down in one direction.
7734
7735 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7736 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7737 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7738
7739 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7740
7741
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007742timeout connect <timeout>
7743timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7744 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7746 yes | no | yes | yes
7747 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007748 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007749 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7750 as explained at the top of this document.
7751
7752 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007753 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007754 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007755 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007756 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7757 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007758
7759 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7760 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7761 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7762 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7763 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7764 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7765
7766 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7767 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7768 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7769
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007770 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7771 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007772
7773
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007774timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7775 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7777 yes | yes | yes | yes
7778 Arguments :
7779 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7780 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7781 as explained at the top of this document.
7782
7783 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7784 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7785 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7786 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7787 once the request has started to present itself.
7788
7789 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7790 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7791 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7792 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7793 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7794
7795 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7796 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7797 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7798 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7799
7800 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7801 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7802 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7803 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7804 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007805 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007806
7807 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7808 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7809 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7810 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7811
7812 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7813
7814
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007815timeout http-request <timeout>
7816 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007818 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007819 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007820 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007821 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7822 as explained at the top of this document.
7823
7824 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7825 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7826 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7827 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7828 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7829 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7830 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007831 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7832 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7833 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7834 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7835 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7836 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7837 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007838
7839 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7840 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007841 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7842 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007843
7844 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7845 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7846 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7847 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7848 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7849
7850 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007851 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7852 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7853 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007854
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007855 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007856
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007857
7858timeout queue <timeout>
7859 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7861 yes | no | yes | yes
7862 Arguments :
7863 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7864 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7865 as explained at the top of this document.
7866
7867 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7868 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7869 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7870 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7871 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7872
7873 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7874 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7875 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7876 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7877
7878 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7879
7880
7881timeout server <timeout>
7882timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7883 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7885 yes | no | yes | yes
7886 Arguments :
7887 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7888 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7889 as explained at the top of this document.
7890
7891 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7892 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7893 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7894 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7895 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7896 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7897 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7898
7899 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7900 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7901 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7902 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7903 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007904 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007905 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007906 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7907 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7908 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7909 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007910
7911 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7912 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7913 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7914 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7915 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7916 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7917
7918 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7919 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7920 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7921
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007922 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007923
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007924
7925timeout server-fin <timeout>
7926 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
7927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7928 yes | no | yes | yes
7929 Arguments :
7930 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7931 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7932 as explained at the top of this document.
7933
7934 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7935 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7936 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7937 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7938 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
7939 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7940 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7941 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
7942 situations, it should not be needed.
7943
7944 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7945 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7946 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
7947
7948 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
7949
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007950
7951timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007952 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7954 yes | yes | yes | yes
7955 Arguments :
7956 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7957 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7958 as explained at the top of this document.
7959
7960 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7961 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7962 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7963
7964 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7965 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7966 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7967 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007968 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007969
7970 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7971
7972
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007973timeout tunnel <timeout>
7974 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7976 yes | no | yes | yes
7977 Arguments :
7978 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7979 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7980 as explained at the top of this document.
7981
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007982 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007983 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7984 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7985 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7986 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7987 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7988 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7989 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7990 specified.
7991
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007992 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
7993 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
7994 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
7995 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
7996 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
7997 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
7998 state.
7999
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008000 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8001 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8002 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8003 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8004 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8005
8006 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8007 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8008 forget about it.
8009
8010 Example :
8011 defaults http
8012 option http-server-close
8013 timeout connect 5s
8014 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008015 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008016 timeout server 30s
8017 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8018
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008019 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008020
8021
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008022transparent (deprecated)
8023 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008025 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008026 Arguments : none
8027
8028 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8029 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8030 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8031 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8032 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8033 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8034 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8035 appropriate server.
8036
8037 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8038
8039 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8040 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8041
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008042 See also: "option transparent"
8043
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008044unique-id-format <string>
8045 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8047 yes | yes | yes | no
8048 Arguments :
8049 <string> is a log-format string.
8050
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008051 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8052 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8053 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8054 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008055
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008056 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8057 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8058 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8059 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8060 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8061 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8062 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8063 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008064
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008065 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8066 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008067
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008068 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008069
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008070 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008071
8072 will generate:
8073
8074 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8075
8076 See also: "unique-id-header"
8077
8078unique-id-header <name>
8079 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8081 yes | yes | yes | no
8082 Arguments :
8083 <name> is the name of the header.
8084
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008085 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8086 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008087
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008088 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008089
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008090 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008091 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8092
8093 will generate:
8094
8095 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8096
8097 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008098
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008099use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008100 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8102 no | yes | yes | no
8103 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008104 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8105 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008106
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008107 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8108 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008109
8110 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8111 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8112 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008113 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8114 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8115 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8116 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008117
8118 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8119 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8120 assign the backend.
8121
8122 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8123 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8124 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8125 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8126 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8127 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8128
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008129 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008130 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008131 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8132 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8133 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8134
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008135 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8136 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8137 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8138 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8139 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8140 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8141 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8142 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8143 cannot be forced from the request.
8144
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008145 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008146 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8147 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8148
8149 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8150 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008151
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008152
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008153use-server <server> if <condition>
8154use-server <server> unless <condition>
8155 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8157 no | no | yes | yes
8158 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008159 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008160
8161 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8162
8163 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8164 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8165 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8166
8167 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8168 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8169 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8170 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8171 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8172 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8173 matches will assign the server.
8174
8175 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8176 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8177 with the next rules until one matches.
8178
8179 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8180 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8181 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8182 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8183
8184 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8185 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8186 stripped.
8187
8188 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8189 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8190 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8191 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8192
8193 Example :
8194 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8195 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8196 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8197 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8198 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8199 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8200 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8201 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8202 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8203
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008204 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008205
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008206
82075. Bind and Server options
8208--------------------------
8209
8210The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8211depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8212settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8213written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8214described in this section.
8215
8216
82175.1. Bind options
8218-----------------
8219
8220The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8221as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8222no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8223parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8224while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8225provided immediately after the setting name.
8226
8227The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8228
8229accept-proxy
8230 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008231 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8232 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008233 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8234 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8235 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8236 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8237 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8238 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8239 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008240 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8241 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008242
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008243alpn <protocols>
8244 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8245 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8246 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8247 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8248 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8249 initial NPN extension.
8250
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008251backlog <backlog>
8252 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8253 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8254
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008255ecdhe <named curve>
8256 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008257 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8258 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008259
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008260ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008261 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8262 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8263 client's certificate.
8264
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008265ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8266 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8267 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8268 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8269 error is ignored.
8270
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008271ciphers <ciphers>
8272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8273 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008274 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008275 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8276 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8277
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008278crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8280 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8281 to verify client's certificate.
8282
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008283crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8285 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8286 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8287 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8288 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8289 file.
8290
8291 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8292 are loaded.
8293
8294 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008295 that directory will be loaded unless their name ends with '.issuer' or
8296 '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified multiple times
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008297 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8298 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8299 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8300 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8301 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8302 www.sub.example.org).
8303
8304 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8305 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8306 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8307 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8308 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8309
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008310 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008311
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008312 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8313 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008314 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008315 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8316 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8317 clients).
8318
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008319 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8320 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8321 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8322 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8323 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8324 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8325 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8326 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8327 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8328 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8329 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8330 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8331 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8332
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008333crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008334 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8335 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008336 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008337 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008338
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008339crt-list <file>
8340 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008341 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8342 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008343
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008344 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008345
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008346 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8347 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8348 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8349 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8350 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8351 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8352 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8353 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008354
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008355defer-accept
8356 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8357 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8358 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8359 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8360 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8361 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8362 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8363 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8364 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8365 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8366 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8367
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008368force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008369 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008370 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8371 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8372
8373force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008374 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008375 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8376
8377force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008378 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008379 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8380
8381force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008382 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008383 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8384
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008385gid <gid>
8386 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8387 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8388 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8389 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8390 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8391
8392group <group>
8393 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8394 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8395 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8396 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8397 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8398
8399id <id>
8400 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8401 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8402 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8403 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8404
8405interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008406 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8407 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8408 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8409 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8410 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8411 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8412 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008413
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008414level <level>
8415 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8416 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8417 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8418 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8419 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8420 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8421 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8422 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8423 counters).
8424 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8425 all counters).
8426
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008427maxconn <maxconn>
8428 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8429 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8430 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8431 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8432 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8433 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8434 eat all memory.
8435
8436mode <mode>
8437 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8438 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8439 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8440 UNIX sockets.
8441
8442mss <maxseg>
8443 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8444 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8445 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8446 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8447 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8448 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8449 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8450 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8451 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8452 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8453 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8454
8455name <name>
8456 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8457 page.
8458
8459nice <nice>
8460 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8461 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8462 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8463 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8464 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8465 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8466 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8467 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8468 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8469 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8470 one for an RDP socket.
8471
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008472no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008473 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008474 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008475 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008476 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8477 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008478
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008479no-tls-tickets
8480 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8481 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8482 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8483 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8484
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008485no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008487 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008488 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8489 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8490 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008491
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008492no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008493 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008494 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008495 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8496 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8497 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008498
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008499no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008500 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008501 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008502 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8503 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8504 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008505
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008506npn <protocols>
8507 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8508 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8509 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8510 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008511 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8512 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008513
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008514process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8515 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8516 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8517 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8518 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8519 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8520 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8521 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008522 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8523 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8524 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8525 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8526 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8527 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8528 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008529
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008530ssl
8531 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008532 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008533 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8534 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8535 to deciphered contents.
8536
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008537strict-sni
8538 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8539 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8540 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8541 See the "crt" option for more information.
8542
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008543tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008544 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008545 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8546 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8547 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8548 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8549 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8550 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8551 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008552 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8553 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8554 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008555
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008556transparent
8557 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8558 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8559 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8560 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8561 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8562 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8563 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8564 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8565 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8566 so check for support with your vendor.
8567
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008568v4v6
8569 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8570 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8571 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8572 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008573 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008574
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008575v6only
8576 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8577 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8578 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008579 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8580 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008581
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008582uid <uid>
8583 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8584 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8585 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8586 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8587 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8588
8589user <user>
8590 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8591 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8592 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8593 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8594 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8595
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008596verify [none|optional|required]
8597 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8598 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8599 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8600 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8601 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008602 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8603 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8604 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8605 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008606
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020086075.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008608------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008610The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8611which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8612arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8613settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8614after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8615Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8616address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008618 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008619 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008621The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008622
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008623addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008624 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8625 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8626 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8627 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8628 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008630 Supported in default-server: No
8631
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008632agent-check
8633 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008634 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8635 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8636 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8637 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008638
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008639 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008640 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8641 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8642
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008643 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8644 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008645
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008646 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8647 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8648 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008649
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008650 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8651 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8652 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008653
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008654 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8655 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8656 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8657 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8658 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8659 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8660 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008661
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008662 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8663 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008664
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008665 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8666 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8667 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8668 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8669 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8670 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8671 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8672 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8673 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008674
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008675 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8676 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008677 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8678 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8679 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8680 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008681
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008682 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8683 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008684
8685 Supported in default-server: No
8686
8687agent-inter <delay>
8688 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8689 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8690
8691 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8692 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8693 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8694 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8695 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8696 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8697 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8698 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8699 of backends use the same servers.
8700
8701 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8702
8703 Supported in default-server: Yes
8704
8705agent-port <port>
8706 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8707
8708 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8709
8710 Supported in default-server: Yes
8711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008712backup
8713 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8714 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8715 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8716 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8717 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8718 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008719
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008720 Supported in default-server: No
8721
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008722ca-file <cafile>
8723 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8724 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8725 server's certificate.
8726
8727 Supported in default-server: No
8728
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008729check
8730 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008731 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8732 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8733 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8734 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8735 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8736 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8737 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008738 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8739 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8740 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008741
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008742 Supported in default-server: No
8743
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008744check-send-proxy
8745 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8746 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8747 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8748 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8749 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8750 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8751 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8752
8753 Supported in default-server: No
8754
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008755check-ssl
8756 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8757 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8758 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8759 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008760 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008761 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8762 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8763 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8764 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8765
8766 Supported in default-server: No
8767
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008768ciphers <ciphers>
8769 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008770 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008771 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8772 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8773 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8774 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8775 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8776 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8777
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008778 Supported in default-server: No
8779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008780cookie <value>
8781 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8782 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8783 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8784 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8785 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8786 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8787 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8788
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008789 Supported in default-server: No
8790
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008791crl-file <crlfile>
8792 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8793 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8794 to verify server's certificate.
8795
8796 Supported in default-server: No
8797
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008798crt <cert>
8799 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8800 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8801 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8802 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8803 certificate request.
8804
8805 Supported in default-server: No
8806
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008807disabled
8808 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8809 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8810 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8811 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8812 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8813
8814 Supported in default-server: No
8815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008816error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008817 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8818 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8819 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008820
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008821 Supported in default-server: Yes
8822
8823 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008824
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008825fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008826 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8827 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8828 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8829
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008830 Supported in default-server: Yes
8831
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008832force-sslv3
8833 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8834 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8835 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8836
8837 Supported in default-server: No
8838
8839force-tlsv10
8840 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8841 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8842
8843 Supported in default-server: No
8844
8845force-tlsv11
8846 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8847 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8848
8849 Supported in default-server: No
8850
8851force-tlsv12
8852 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8853 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8854
8855 Supported in default-server: No
8856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008857id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008858 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8859 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8860 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008861
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008862 Supported in default-server: No
8863
8864inter <delay>
8865fastinter <delay>
8866downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008867 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8868 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8869 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8870 between checks depending on the server state :
8871
8872 Server state | Interval used
8873 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8874 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8875 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8876 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8877 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8878 or yet unchecked. |
8879 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8880 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8881 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008882
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008883 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8884 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8885 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8886 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008887 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8888 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8889 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8890 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8891 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008893 Supported in default-server: Yes
8894
8895maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008896 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8897 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8898 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8899 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8900 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8901 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8902 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8903 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8904
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008905 Supported in default-server: Yes
8906
8907maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008908 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8909 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8910 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8911 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8912 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8913 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8914 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8915
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008916 Supported in default-server: Yes
8917
8918minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008919 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8920 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8921 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8922 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8923 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8924 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008925 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008926 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008927
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008928 Supported in default-server: Yes
8929
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008930no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008931 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8932 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008933 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008934
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008935 Supported in default-server: No
8936
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008937no-tls-tickets
8938 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8939 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8940 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8941 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8942
8943 Supported in default-server: No
8944
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008945no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008946 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008947 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8948 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008949 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8950 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008951
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008952 Supported in default-server: No
8953
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008954no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008955 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008956 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8957 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008958 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8959 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008960
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008961 Supported in default-server: No
8962
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008963no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008964 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008965 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8966 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008967 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8968 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008969
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008970 Supported in default-server: No
8971
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008972non-stick
8973 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8974 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8975 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8976
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008977 Supported in default-server: No
8978
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008979observe <mode>
8980 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8981 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8982 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8983 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8984 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8985 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008986 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008987
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008988 Supported in default-server: No
8989
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008990 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008992on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008993 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8994 Currently, four modes are available:
8995 - fastinter: force fastinter
8996 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8997 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8998 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8999 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9000
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009001 Supported in default-server: Yes
9002
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009003 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9004
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009005on-marked-down <action>
9006 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9007 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009008 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9009 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9010 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9011 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9012 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9013 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9014 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9015 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009016
9017 Actions are disabled by default
9018
9019 Supported in default-server: Yes
9020
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009021on-marked-up <action>
9022 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9023 Currently one action is available:
9024 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9025 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9026 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9027 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9028 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9029 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9030 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9031 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9032
9033 Actions are disabled by default
9034
9035 Supported in default-server: Yes
9036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009037port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009038 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9039 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9040 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9041 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9042 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9043 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9044
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009045 Supported in default-server: Yes
9046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009047redir <prefix>
9048 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9049 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9050 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9051 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9052 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9053 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9054 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9055 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009056 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009057 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9058 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9059 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9060 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9061 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9062
9063 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9064
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009065 Supported in default-server: No
9066
9067rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009068 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9069 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9070 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9071
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009072 Supported in default-server: Yes
9073
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009074send-proxy
9075 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9076 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9077 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9078 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9079 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9080 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9081 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9082 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9083 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009084 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9085 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9086 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9087 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9088 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009089
9090 Supported in default-server: No
9091
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009092send-proxy-v2
9093 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9094 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9095 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9096 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9097 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9098 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9099 option of the "bind" keyword.
9100
9101 Supported in default-server: No
9102
9103send-proxy-v2-ssl
9104 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9105 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9106 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9107 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9108 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9109 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9110 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9111 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9112
9113 Supported in default-server: No
9114
9115send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9116 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9117 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9118 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9119 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9120 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9121 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9122 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9123 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9124 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9125
9126 Supported in default-server: No
9127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009128slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009129 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9130 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9131 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9132 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9133 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9134 parameters :
9135
9136 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9137 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9138
9139 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9140 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9141 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9142 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9143
9144 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9145 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9146 seen as failed.
9147
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009148 Supported in default-server: Yes
9149
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009150source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009151source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009152source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009153 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9154 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9155 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9156 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9157
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009158 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9159 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9160 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9161 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9162 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9163 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9164 server.
9165
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009166 Supported in default-server: No
9167
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009168ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009169 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9170 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9171 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9172 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9173 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9174 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009175 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009176
9177 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009179track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009180 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9181 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9182 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9183 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009184 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9185
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009186 Supported in default-server: No
9187
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009188verify [none|required]
9189 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009190 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9191 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9192 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9193 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009194 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9195 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9196 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009197
9198 Supported in default-server: No
9199
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009200verifyhost <hostname>
9201 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9202 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9203 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9204 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9205 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9206 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9207
9208 Supported in default-server: No
9209
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009210weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009211 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9212 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9213 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009214 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9215 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9216 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9217 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9218 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9219 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009221 Supported in default-server: Yes
9222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009223
92246. HTTP header manipulation
9225---------------------------
9226
9227In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9228response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9229request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9230which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009231against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009232
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009233If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9234to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9235but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9236HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9237stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9238because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9239a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9240still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009242This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9243in section 4.2 :
9244
9245 - reqadd <string>
9246 - reqallow <search>
9247 - reqiallow <search>
9248 - reqdel <search>
9249 - reqidel <search>
9250 - reqdeny <search>
9251 - reqideny <search>
9252 - reqpass <search>
9253 - reqipass <search>
9254 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9255 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9256 - reqtarpit <search>
9257 - reqitarpit <search>
9258 - rspadd <string>
9259 - rspdel <search>
9260 - rspidel <search>
9261 - rspdeny <search>
9262 - rspideny <search>
9263 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9264 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9265
9266With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9267is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9268parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9269prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9270Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9271
9272 \t for a tab
9273 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9274 \n for a new line (LF)
9275 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9276 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9277 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9278 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9279 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9280
9281The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9282portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9283above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9284regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
92859 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9286is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9287
9288The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9289after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9290
9291Notes related to these keywords :
9292---------------------------------
9293 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9294 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9295 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9296
9297 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9298 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9299 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9300
9301 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9302 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9303 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9304 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9305 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9306
9307 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9308 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9309 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9310 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9311 useless headers before adding new ones.
9312
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009313 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009314 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9315
9316 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9317 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9318 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9319
9320 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9321 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009322 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009323
9324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093257. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9326----------------------------------
9327
9328Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9329client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9330The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9331these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9332but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9333data called patterns.
9334
9335
93367.1. ACL basics
9337---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009338
9339The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9340content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9341from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9342simple :
9343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009344 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009345 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009346 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9347 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009349The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9350adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009351
9352In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009354 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009355
9356This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9357Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9358and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009359an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9360conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9361as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9362are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009363
9364ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9365'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9366which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9367
9368There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9369performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009371The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9372specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9373this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009374methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9375ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009376
9377Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9378 - boolean
9379 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9380 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9381 - string
9382 - data block
9383
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009384Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9385converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9386would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9387The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9388which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9389
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009390Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9391keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9392fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9393which are summarized in the table below :
9394
9395 +---------------------+-----------------+
9396 | Sample or converter | Default |
9397 | output type | matching method |
9398 +---------------------+-----------------+
9399 | boolean | bool |
9400 +---------------------+-----------------+
9401 | integer | int |
9402 +---------------------+-----------------+
9403 | ip | ip |
9404 +---------------------+-----------------+
9405 | string | str |
9406 +---------------------+-----------------+
9407 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9408 +---------------------+-----------------+
9409
9410Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9411matching method, see below.
9412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009413The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9414 - boolean
9415 - integer or integer range
9416 - IP address / network
9417 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9418 - regular expression
9419 - hex block
9420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009421The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9422
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009423 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9424 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009425 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009426 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009427 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009428 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009429 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009431The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9432read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9433if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9434lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9435will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9436beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9437a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9438lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9439exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9440
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009441The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9442parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9443ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9444a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9445check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9446
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009447The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9448socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9449file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009451Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9452loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9453
9454 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9455
9456In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9457the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9458case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9459as well.
9460
9461The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9462sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9463do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9464methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9465is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9466obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9467followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9468default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9469that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9470string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9471
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009472The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9473By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9474string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9475resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9476server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9477waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9478flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9479function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009481There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9482sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9483be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009484
9485 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9486 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009487 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9488 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9489 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9490 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009491
9492 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9493 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009494 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009495
9496 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009497 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009498
9499 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009500 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009501
9502 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9503 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9504
9505 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9506 binary or string samples.
9507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009508 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9509 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009511 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9512 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9513 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009515 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9516 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009518 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9519 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009521 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9522 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009524 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9525 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009526 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009528 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9529 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9530 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009531
9532For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9533request, it is possible to do :
9534
9535 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9536
9537In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9538buffer, one would use the following acl :
9539
9540 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9541
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009542On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9543possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9544
9545 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009547All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9548criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9549method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9550to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9551criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9552the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009554If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009555the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9556For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009558 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9559 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9560 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9561 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009562
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009563
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009564The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9565types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9566combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9567brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9568default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009570 +-------------------------------------------------+
9571 | Input sample type |
9572 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009573 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009574 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9575 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9576 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009577 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009578 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009579 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009580 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009581 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009582 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009583 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009584 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009585 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009586 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009587 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009588 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009589 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009590 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009591 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009592 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009593 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009594 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009595 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009596 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009597 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009598 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9599 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9600 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009601
9602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096037.1.1. Matching booleans
9604------------------------
9605
9606In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9607Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9608When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9609that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9610
9611Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9612return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9613"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9614
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096167.1.2. Matching integers
9617------------------------
9618
9619Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9620enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9621to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9622
9623Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9624matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9625lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009626
9627For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9628unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9629representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9630
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009631As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9632two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9633instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9634ranges and operators.
9635
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009636For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009637operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9638Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9639of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009641Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009642
9643 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9644 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9645 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9646 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9647 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9648
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009649For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009650
9651 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9652
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009653This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9654
9655 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9656
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096587.1.3. Matching strings
9659-----------------------
9660
9661String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9662different forms :
9663
9664 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9665 patterns ;
9666
9667 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9668 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9669
9670 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9671 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9672
9673 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9674 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9675
9676 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9677 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9678 matches.
9679
9680 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9681 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9682 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009683
9684String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9685exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9686characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9687string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9688to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009689before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009690
9691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096927.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9693---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009694
9695Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9696they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9697possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9698passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9699the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009700the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9701match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009702
9703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097047.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9705-------------------------------------
9706
9707It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9708not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9709a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9710to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9711digits may be used upper or lower case.
9712
9713Example :
9714 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9715 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9716
9717
97187.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9719---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009720
9721IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9722netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9723within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009724host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009725difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9726at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9727does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9728parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009729
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009730IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9731Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9732trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9733IPv6 patterns.
9734
9735HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9736following situations :
9737 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9738 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9739 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9740 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9741 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9742 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9743 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9744 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9745 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9746 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009748
97497.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9750----------------------------------
9751
9752Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9753combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9754
9755 - AND (implicit)
9756 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9757 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009759A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009761 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009763Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9764indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009766For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9767"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9768requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9769is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9770
9771 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9772 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9773 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9774 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9775
9776To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9777and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9778
9779 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9780 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9781 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9782 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9783
9784 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9785 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9786 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9787 use_backend www if host_www
9788
9789It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9790expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9791be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9792the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9793
9794 The following rule :
9795
9796 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9797 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9798
9799 Can also be written that way :
9800
9801 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9802
9803It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9804to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9805simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9806sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9807good use is the following :
9808
9809 With named ACLs :
9810
9811 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9812 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9813 monitor fail if site_dead
9814
9815 With anonymous ACLs :
9816
9817 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9818
9819See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9820
9821
98227.3. Fetching samples
9823---------------------
9824
9825Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9826against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9827sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9828ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9829of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9830available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9831
9832This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9833Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9834compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9835deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9836
9837The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9838matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9839method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9840indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9841
9842As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9843when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9844mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9845the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9846ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9847
9848Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9849multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9850when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9851incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9852are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9853is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9854all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9855
9856Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9857 - name
9858 - name(arg1)
9859 - name(arg1,arg2)
9860
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009861
98627.3.1. Converters
9863-----------------
9864
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009865Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9866of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9867is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9868was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9869has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9870unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9871
9872These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9873sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9874the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9875support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009877The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009878
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009879base64
9880 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9881 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9882 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9883
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009884lower
9885 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9886 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9887 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009888
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009889upper
9890 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
9891 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9892 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009893
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009894hex
9895 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9896 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9897 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9898 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009899
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009900ipmask(<mask>)
9901 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9902 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9903 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9904 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009905
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009906http_date([<offset>])
9907 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9908 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9909 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9910 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9911 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9912 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009913
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009914language(<value>[,<default>])
9915 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9916 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9917 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9918 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9919 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9920 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9921 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9922 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9923 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9924 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9925 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9926 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009927
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009928 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009929
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009930 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9931 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009932
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009933 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9934 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9935 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9936 use_backend spanish if es
9937 use_backend french if fr
9938 use_backend english if en
9939 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009940
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009941map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9942map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9943map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9944 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9945 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9946 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9947 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9948 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9949 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9950 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9951 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009952
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009953 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9954 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
9955 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009956
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009957 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
9958 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009959
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009960 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
9961 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9962 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
9963 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +02009964 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
9965 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009966 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
9967 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9968 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
9969 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9970 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
9971 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9972 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
9973 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9974 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
9975 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9976 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
9977 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9978 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
9979 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009980
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009981 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
9982 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
9983 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
9984 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9985 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009986
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009987 Example :
9988
9989 # this is a comment and is ignored
9990 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9991 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9992 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9993 | | | `---------- value
9994 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
9995 | `---------------------------- key
9996 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9997
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009998
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020099997.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010000--------------------------------------------
10001
10002A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10003not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10004"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10005The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10006
10007always_false : boolean
10008 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10009 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10010
10011always_true : boolean
10012 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10013 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10014
10015avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010016 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010017 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10018 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10019 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10020 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10021 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10022 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10023 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10024 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10025 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10026 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10027 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10028 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10029 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010031be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010032 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10033 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10034 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10035 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10036 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010038be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10039 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10040 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10041 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10042 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10043 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10044 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010045
10046 Example :
10047 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10048 backend dynamic
10049 mode http
10050 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10051 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010053connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10054 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010055 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010056 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10057 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010058
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010059 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010060 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010061 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10062
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010063 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10064 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010065
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010066 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010067 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010068 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010069 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10070 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010071 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010072 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010073
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010074 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10075 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010076 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010077 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010078
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010079date([<offset>]) : integer
10080 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10081 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10082 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10083 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010084 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10085
10086 Example :
10087
10088 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10089 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010090
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010091env(<name>) : string
10092 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10093 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10094 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10095 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10096 certain way.
10097
10098 Examples :
10099 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10100 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10101
10102 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10103 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010105fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10106 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010107 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10108 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010109 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10110 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10111 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10112 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10113 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010115fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10116 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10117 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10118 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10119 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10120 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10121 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10122 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10123 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010124
10125 Example :
10126 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10127 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10128 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10129 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10130 frontend mail
10131 bind :25
10132 mode tcp
10133 maxconn 100
10134 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10135 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10136 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10137 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010139nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10140 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10141 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10142 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010143 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10144 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10145 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010147queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010148 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10149 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10150 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010151 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10152 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10153 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10154 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10155 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10156
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010157rand([<range>]) : integer
10158 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10159 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10160 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10161 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10162 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010164srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10165 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10166 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10167 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10168 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10169 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10170 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10171 methods.
10172
10173srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10174 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10175 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10176 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10177 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10178 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10179 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10180 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10181
10182srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10183 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10184 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010185 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010186 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10187 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10188 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10189 overloading servers).
10190
10191 Example :
10192 # Redirect to a separate back
10193 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10194 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10195 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10196
10197table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10198 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10199 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10200
10201table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10202 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10203 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10204 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10205
10206
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200102077.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010208----------------------------------
10209
10210The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10211closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10212methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10213sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10214TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010215the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10216counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10217"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010218argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10219the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10220this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010221
10222be_id : integer
10223 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10224 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10225
10226dst : ip
10227 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10228 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10229 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10230 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10231 RFC 4291.
10232
10233dst_conn : integer
10234 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10235 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10236 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10237 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10238 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10239 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10240 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10241 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010243dst_port : integer
10244 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10245 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10246 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10247 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10248 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10249 an HTTP header.
10250
10251fe_id : integer
10252 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10253 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10254 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10255
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010256sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010257sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10258sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10259sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010260 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10261 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10262 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10263
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010264sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010265sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10266sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10267sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010268 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10269 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10270 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10271
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010272sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010273sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10274sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10275sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010276 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10277 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010278 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10279 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10280 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010281
10282 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10283 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010284 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10285 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10286 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010287 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10288 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10289
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010290sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010291sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10292sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10293sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010294 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10295 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10296
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010297sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010298sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10299sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10300sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010301 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10302 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10303 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10304
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010305sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010306sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10307sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10308sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010309 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10310 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10311 See also src_conn_rate.
10312
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010313sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010314sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10315sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10316sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010317 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010318 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010319
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010320sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010321sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10322sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10323sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010324 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10325 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10326 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010327 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10328 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10329 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010330
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010331sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010332sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10333sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10334sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010335 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10336 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10337 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10338
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010339sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010340sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10341sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10342sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010343 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10344 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10345 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10346 src_http_err_rate.
10347
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010348sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010349sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10350sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10351sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010352 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10353 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10354 src_http_req_cnt.
10355
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010356sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010357sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10358sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10359sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010360 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10361 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10362 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10363 src_http_req_rate.
10364
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010365sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010366sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10367sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10368sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010369 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010370 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10371 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10372 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10373 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010374
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010375 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10376 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010377 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10378
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010379sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010380sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10381sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10382sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010383 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10384 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10385 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10386 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
10387
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010388sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010389sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10390sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10391sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010392 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10393 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10394 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10395 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
10396
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010397sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010398sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10399sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10400sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010401 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10402 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10403 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10404 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010405 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010406 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10407
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010408sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010409sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10410sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10411sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010412 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10413 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10414 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10415 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10416 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010417 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010418
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010419sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010420sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10421sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10422sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010423 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10424 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10425 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10426
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010427sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010428sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10429sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10430sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010431 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10432 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010433 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010434 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10435 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010436 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10437 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10438 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010440so_id : integer
10441 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10442 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10443 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010445src : ip
10446 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10447 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10448 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10449 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10450 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10451 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10452 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010453
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010454 Example:
10455 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10456 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010458src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10459 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10460 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10461 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010462 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010464src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10465 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10466 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010467 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010468 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010470src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10471 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10472 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10473 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10474 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10475 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10476 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010477
10478 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10479 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10480 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10481 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010482 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010483 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10484 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010486src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010487 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010488 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010489 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010490 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010492src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010493 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010494 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10495 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010496 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010498src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10499 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10500 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10501 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010502 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010504src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010505 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010506 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010507 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010508 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010510src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010511 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010512 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010513 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10514 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010515 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10516 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10517 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010519src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10520 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10521 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010522 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010523 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010524 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010526src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10527 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10528 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10529 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10530 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010531 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010533src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10534 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10535 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10536 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010537 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010539src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10540 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10541 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10542 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010543 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010544 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010546src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10547 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10548 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10549 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010550 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010551 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10552 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010553
10554 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010555 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010556 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010558src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10559 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10560 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10561 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10562 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010563 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10564 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010566src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10567 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10568 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010569 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10570 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010571 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010573src_port : integer
10574 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10575 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10576 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10577 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010579src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10580 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010581 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10582 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10583 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010584 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010586src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10587 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10588 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10589 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10590 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010591 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010593src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10594 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10595 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10596 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10597 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10598 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10599 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10600 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10601 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010602
10603 Example :
10604 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10605 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10606 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10607 listen ssh
10608 bind :22
10609 mode tcp
10610 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010611 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010612 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010613 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010615srv_id : integer
10616 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10617 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10618 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010619
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010620
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106217.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010622----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010624The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10625closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10626when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10627usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010628future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010629
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010630ssl_bc : boolean
10631 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10632 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10633 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10634
10635ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10636 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10637 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10638
10639ssl_bc_cipher : string
10640 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10641 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10642
10643ssl_bc_protocol : string
10644 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10645 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10646
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010647ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010648 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010649 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10650 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010651
10652ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10653 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10654 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10655 if session was reused or not.
10656
10657ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10658 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10659 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010661ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10662 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10663 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10664 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10665 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10666 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010668ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10669 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10670 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10671 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10672 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010674ssl_c_err : integer
10675 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10676 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10677 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10678 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10679 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010681ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10682 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10683 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10684 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10685 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10686 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10687 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10688 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10689 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010691ssl_c_key_alg : string
10692 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10693 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10694 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010696ssl_c_notafter : string
10697 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10698 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10699 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010701ssl_c_notbefore : string
10702 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10703 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10704 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010706ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10707 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10708 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10709 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10710 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10711 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10712 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10713 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10714 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010716ssl_c_serial : binary
10717 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10718 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10719 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010721ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10722 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10723 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10724 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau9fe4cb62014-07-02 19:01:22 +020010725 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
10726 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
10727
10728 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010730ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10731 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10732 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10733 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010735ssl_c_used : boolean
10736 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10737 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010739ssl_c_verify : integer
10740 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10741 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10742 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10743 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010745ssl_c_version : integer
10746 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10747 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010749ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10750 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10751 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10752 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10753 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010754 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010755 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10756 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10757 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010759ssl_f_key_alg : string
10760 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10761 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10762 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010764ssl_f_notafter : string
10765 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10766 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10767 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010769ssl_f_notbefore : string
10770 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10771 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10772 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010774ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10775 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10776 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10777 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10778 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10779 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10780 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10781 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10782 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010784ssl_f_serial : binary
10785 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10786 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10787 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010788
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010789ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10790 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10791 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10792 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010794ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10795 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10796 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10797 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010799ssl_f_version : integer
10800 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10801 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10802
10803ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010804 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10805 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10806 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010808 Example :
10809 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10810 listen http-https
10811 bind :80
10812 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10813 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10814
10815ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10816 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10817 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10818
10819ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010820 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010821 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10822 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10823 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10824 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10825 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10826 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10827 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10828 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010830ssl_fc_cipher : string
10831 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10832 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010834ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010835 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10836 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010837 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10838 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10839 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10840 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010842ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10843 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010844 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10845 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10846 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10847 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010849ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010850 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010851 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10852 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10853 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10854 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10855 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10856 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10857 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010859ssl_fc_protocol : string
10860 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10861 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010862
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010863ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010864 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010865 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10866 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010868ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10869 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10870 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10871 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10872 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010874ssl_fc_sni : string
10875 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10876 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10877 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10878 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10879 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10880
10881 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10882 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10883 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010884 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10885 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010887 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010888 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10889 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010891ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10892 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10893 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010894
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010895
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200108967.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010897------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010899Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10900sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10901only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10902For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10903be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10904can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10905sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10906for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10907content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010909payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10910 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10911 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10912 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010914payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10915 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10916 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10917 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010919req.len : integer
10920req_len : integer (deprecated)
10921 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10922 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10923 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10924 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10925 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10926 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10927 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10928 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010930req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10931 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010932 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10933 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10934 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10935 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010937 ACL alternatives :
10938 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010940req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10941 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10942 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10943 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10944 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010946 ACL alternatives :
10947 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010949 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010951req.proto_http : boolean
10952req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10953 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10954 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10955 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10956 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10957 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10958 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10959 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010961 Example:
10962 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10963 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10964 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010965 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010967req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10968rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10969 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10970 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10971 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10972 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10973 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10974 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10975 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010977 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10978 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10979 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10980 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10981 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10982 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010984 ACL derivatives :
10985 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010987 Example :
10988 listen tse-farm
10989 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10990 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10991 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10992 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10993 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10994 persist rdp-cookie
10995 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10996 # This is only useful makes sense if
10997 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10998 stick-table type string size 204800
10999 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11000 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11001 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011003 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11004 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011006req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11007rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11008 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11009 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11010 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11011 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011013 ACL derivatives :
11014 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011016req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11017req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11018 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11019 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11020 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11021 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11022 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11023 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11024 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011026req.ssl_sni : string
11027req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11028 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11029 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11030 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11031 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11032 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11033 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11034 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11035 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11036 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11037 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11038 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11039 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011041 ACL derivatives :
11042 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011044 Examples :
11045 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11046 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11047 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11048 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11049 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011051res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11052rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11053 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11054 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11055 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11056 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11057 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11058 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11059 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011061req.ssl_ver : integer
11062req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11063 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11064 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11065 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11066 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11067 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11068 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11069 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11070 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11071 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011073 ACL derivatives :
11074 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011075
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011076res.len : integer
11077 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11078 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11079 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11080 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11081 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11082 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11083 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11084 content inspection.
11085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011086res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11087 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011088 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11089 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11090 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11091 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011093res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11094 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11095 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11096 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11097 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011099 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011101wait_end : boolean
11102 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11103 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11104 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11105 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11106 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11107 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11108 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11109 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011111 Examples :
11112 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11113 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11114 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011116 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11117 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11118 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11119 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11120 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11121 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11122 tcp-request content reject
11123
11124
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200111257.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011126--------------------------------------
11127
11128It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11129This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11130data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11131its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11132HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11133content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11134to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11135more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11136response are indexed.
11137
11138base : string
11139 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11140 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11141 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11142 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11143 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11144 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11145 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11146 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11147
11148 ACL derivatives :
11149 base : exact string match
11150 base_beg : prefix match
11151 base_dir : subdir match
11152 base_dom : domain match
11153 base_end : suffix match
11154 base_len : length match
11155 base_reg : regex match
11156 base_sub : substring match
11157
11158base32 : integer
11159 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11160 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11161 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11162 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11163
11164base32+src : binary
11165 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11166 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11167 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11168 per-URL counters.
11169
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011170capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11171 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11172 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11173 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11174
11175capture.req.method : string
11176 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11177 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11178 because it's allocated.
11179
11180capture.req.uri : string
11181 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11182 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11183 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11184 allocated.
11185
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011186capture.req.ver : string
11187 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11188 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11189 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11190
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011191capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11192 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11193 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11194 The first entry is an index of 0.
11195 See also: "capture response header"
11196
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011197capture.res.ver : string
11198 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11199 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11200 persistent flag.
11201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011202req.cook([<name>]) : string
11203cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11204 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11205 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11206 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11207 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11208 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11209 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11210 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11211 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11212
11213 ACL derivatives :
11214 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11215 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11216 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11217 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11218 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11219 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11220 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11221 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011223req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11224cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11225 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11226 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011228req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11229cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11230 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11231 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11232 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11233 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011235cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11236 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11237 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11238 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11239 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11240 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11241 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11242 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11243 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11244 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11245 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011247hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11248 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11249 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11250 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11251 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011252 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011254req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11255 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11256 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11257 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11258 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11259 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11260 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11261 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11262 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011264req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11265 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11266 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11267 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11268 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011270req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11271 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11272 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11273 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11274 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11275 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11276 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11277 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11278 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11279 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11280 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11281 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011283 ACL derivatives :
11284 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11285 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11286 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11287 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11288 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11289 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11290 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11291 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11292
11293req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11294hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11295 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11296 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11297 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11298 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11299 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11300 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11301 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11302 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11303 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11304
11305req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11306hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11307 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11308 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11309 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11310 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11311 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11312 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11313 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11314 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11315
11316req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11317hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11318 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11319 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11320 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11321 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11322 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11323 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11324 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11325
11326http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11327 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11328 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11329 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11330 basic auth is supported.
11331
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011332http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11333 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11334 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11335 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11336 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011337 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11338 basic auth is supported.
11339
11340 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011341 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11342 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11343 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11344 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011345
11346http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011347 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11348 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011349 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11350 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011352method : integer + string
11353 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11354 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11355 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11356 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11357 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11358 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11359 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011361 ACL derivatives :
11362 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011364 Example :
11365 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11366 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11367 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011369path : string
11370 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11371 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11372 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11373 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11374 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11375 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11376 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011378 ACL derivatives :
11379 path : exact string match
11380 path_beg : prefix match
11381 path_dir : subdir match
11382 path_dom : domain match
11383 path_end : suffix match
11384 path_len : length match
11385 path_reg : regex match
11386 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011388req.ver : string
11389req_ver : string (deprecated)
11390 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11391 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11392 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011394 ACL derivatives :
11395 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011397res.comp : boolean
11398 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11399 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11400 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011402res.comp_algo : string
11403 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11404 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11405 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011407res.cook([<name>]) : string
11408scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11409 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11410 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11411 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011413 ACL derivatives :
11414 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011416res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11417scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11418 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11419 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11420 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011422res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11423scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11424 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11425 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11426 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011428res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11429 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11430 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11431 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11432 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11433 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11434 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11435 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11436 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11437 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011439res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11440 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11441 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11442 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11443 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11444 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011446res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11447shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11448 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11449 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11450 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11451 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11452 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11453 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11454 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11455 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011457 ACL derivatives :
11458 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11459 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11460 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11461 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11462 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11463 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11464 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11465 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11466
11467res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11468shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11469 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11470 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11471 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11472 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11473 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011475res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11476shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11477 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11478 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11479 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11480 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11481 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11482 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011484res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11485shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11486 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11487 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11488 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11489 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11490 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11491 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011493res.ver : string
11494resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11495 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11496 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011498 ACL derivatives :
11499 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011501set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11502 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11503 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11504 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11505 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011507 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11508 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011510 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011512status : integer
11513 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11514 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11515 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011517url : string
11518 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11519 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11520 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11521 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11522 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11523 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11524 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011526 ACL derivatives :
11527 url : exact string match
11528 url_beg : prefix match
11529 url_dir : subdir match
11530 url_dom : domain match
11531 url_end : suffix match
11532 url_len : length match
11533 url_reg : regex match
11534 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011536url_ip : ip
11537 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11538 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11539 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11540 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11541 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11542 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11543 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011545url_port : integer
11546 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11547 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11548 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11549 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011551urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11552url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11553 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11554 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11555 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11556 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11557 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11558 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11559 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11560 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11561 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011563 ACL derivatives :
11564 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11565 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11566 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11567 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11568 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11569 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11570 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11571 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011572
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011574 Example :
11575 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11576 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11577 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11578 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011580urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11581 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11582 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11583 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011584
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115867.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011587---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011589Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11590every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011591order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011593ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11594---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011595FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011596HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011597HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11598HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011599HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11600HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11601HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11602HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11603LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011604METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11605METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11606METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11607METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11608METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11609METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011610RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011611REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011612TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011613WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11614---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011615
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011616
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116178. Logging
11618----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011619
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011620One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11621provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11622very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11623provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11624state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011625to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011626headers.
11627
11628In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11629about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11630send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11631
11632 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11633 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11634 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11635 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11636 at the termination.
11637
11638The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11639allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11640as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11641while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11642real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11643delay.
11644
11645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116468.1. Log levels
11647---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011648
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011649TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011650source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011651HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11652in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11653track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11654syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11655about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011656
11657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116588.2. Log formats
11659----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011660
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011661HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011662and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11663slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11664options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011665
11666 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11667 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11668 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11669 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11670 extents.
11671
11672 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11673 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11674 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11675 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11676 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11677
11678 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11679 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11680 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11681 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11682 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11683
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011684 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11685 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11686 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11687 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11688
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011689 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11690
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011691Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11692specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11693field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11694servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11695always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11696identifier.
11697
11698Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11699 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11700 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11701 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11702 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11703
11704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117058.2.1. Default log format
11706-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011707
11708This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11709as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11710format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11711
11712 Example :
11713 listen www
11714 mode http
11715 log global
11716 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11717
11718 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11719 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11720 (www/HTTP)
11721
11722 Field Format Extract from the example above
11723 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11724 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11725 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11726 4 'to' to
11727 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11728 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11729
11730Detailed fields description :
11731 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11732 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11733 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11734 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11735 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11736 and processed the connection.
11737 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11738
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011739In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11740"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11741connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11742
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011743It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11744will eventually disappear.
11745
11746
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117478.2.2. TCP log format
11748---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011749
11750The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11751is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11752information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11753counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11754emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11755environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11756the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11757sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011758specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11759not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11760fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11761marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011762
11763 Example :
11764 frontend fnt
11765 mode tcp
11766 option tcplog
11767 log global
11768 default_backend bck
11769
11770 backend bck
11771 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11772
11773 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11774 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11775 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11776
11777 Field Format Extract from the example above
11778 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11779 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11780 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11781 4 frontend_name fnt
11782 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11783 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11784 7 bytes_read* 212
11785 8 termination_state --
11786 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11787 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11788
11789Detailed fields description :
11790 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011791 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11792 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11793 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11794 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11795 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011796
11797 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011798 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11799 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11800 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011801
11802 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11803 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11804 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11805 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11806
11807 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11808 and processed the connection.
11809
11810 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11811 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11812 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11813 applications.
11814
11815 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11816 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11817 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11818 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11819 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11820
11821 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11822 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11823 See "Timers" below for more details.
11824
11825 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11826 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11827 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11828 "Timers" below for more details.
11829
11830 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011831 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011832 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11833 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11834 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11835 details.
11836
11837 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11838 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11839 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11840 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11841 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11842
11843 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11844 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11845 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11846 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11847 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11848 for more details.
11849
11850 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011851 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011852 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11853 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11854 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011855 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011856
11857 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11858 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11859 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11860 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11861 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11862 caused by a denial of service attack.
11863
11864 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11865 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11866 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11867 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11868 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11869 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11870 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11871 denial of service attack.
11872
11873 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11874 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11875 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11876 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11877 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11878 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11879 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11880 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11881 be processed than on other servers.
11882
11883 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11884 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11885 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11886 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11887 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11888 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11889 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11890 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11891 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11892 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11893 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11894 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11895 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11896
11897 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11898 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11899 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11900 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11901 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11902 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11903 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11904 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11905
11906 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11907 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11908 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11909 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11910 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11911 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11912 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11913 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11914 occurs.
11915
11916
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119178.2.3. HTTP log format
11918----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011919
11920The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11921is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11922the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11923are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11924emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11925generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11926"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11927which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011928frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11929is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011930
11931Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11932slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11933with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11934
11935 Example :
11936 frontend http-in
11937 mode http
11938 option httplog
11939 log global
11940 default_backend bck
11941
11942 backend static
11943 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11944
11945 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11946 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11947 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011948 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011949
11950 Field Format Extract from the example above
11951 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11952 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11953 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11954 4 frontend_name http-in
11955 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11956 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11957 7 status_code 200
11958 8 bytes_read* 2750
11959 9 captured_request_cookie -
11960 10 captured_response_cookie -
11961 11 termination_state ----
11962 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11963 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11964 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11965 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11966 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011967
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011968
11969Detailed fields description :
11970 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011971 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11972 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11973 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11974 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11975 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011976
11977 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011978 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11979 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11980 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011981
11982 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11983 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11984 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11985 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11986 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11987
11988 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11989 and processed the connection.
11990
11991 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11992 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11993 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11994
11995 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11996 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11997 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11998 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11999 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12000 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12001
12002 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12003 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12004 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12005 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12006 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12007 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12008
12009 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12010 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12011 See "Timers" below for more details.
12012
12013 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12014 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12015 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12016 below for more details.
12017
12018 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12019 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12020 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12021 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12022 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12023 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12024 for more details.
12025
12026 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012027 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012028 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12029 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12030 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12031 details.
12032
12033 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12034 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12035 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12036
12037 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12038 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12039 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12040 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12041 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12042 overflowing.
12043
12044 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12045 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12046 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12047 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12048 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12049 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12050 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12051 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12052
12053 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12054 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12055 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12056 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12057 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12058 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12059 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12060 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12061
12062 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12063 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12064 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12065 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12066 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12067 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12068 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12069
12070 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012071 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012072 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12073 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12074 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012075 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012076 system.
12077
12078 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12079 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12080 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12081 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12082 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12083 caused by a denial of service attack.
12084
12085 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12086 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12087 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12088 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12089 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12090 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12091 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12092 denial of service attack.
12093
12094 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12095 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12096 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12097 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12098 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12099 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12100 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12101 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12102 processed than on other servers.
12103
12104 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12105 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12106 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12107 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12108 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12109 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12110 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12111 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12112 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12113 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12114 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12115 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12116 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12117
12118 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12119 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12120 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12121 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12122 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12123 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12124 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12125 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12126
12127 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12128 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12129 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12130 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12131 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12132 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12133 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12134 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12135 occurs.
12136
12137 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12138 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12139 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12140 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12141 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12142 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12143 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12144 cookies" below for more details.
12145
12146 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12147 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12148 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12149 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12150 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12151 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12152 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12153 and cookies" below for more details.
12154
12155 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12156 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12157 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12158 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12159 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12160 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12161 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12162 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12163
12164
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200121658.2.4. Custom log format
12166------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012167
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012168The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012169mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012170
12171HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12172Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12173separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12174prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12175
12176Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12177variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12178string formats ("Q").
12179
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012180If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012181as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012182less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12183the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12184
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012185Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012186In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012187in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012188
12189Flags are :
12190 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012191 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012192
12193 Example:
12194
12195 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12196 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12197
12198At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12199
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012200 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12201 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012202
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012203the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012204
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012205 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012206 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012207 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012208
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012209and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12210
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012211 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012212 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12213
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012214Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12215
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012216 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012217 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012218 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12219 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12220 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012221 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12222 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12223 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012224 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012225 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012226 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012227 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012228 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012229 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012230 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12231 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012232 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012233 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12234 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012235 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012236 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12237 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012238 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12239 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12240 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012241 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012242 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12243 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012244 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012245 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12246 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12247 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012248 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012249 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12250 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12251 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12252 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012253 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012254 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012255 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012256 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012257 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012258 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012259 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12260 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12261 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012262 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012263 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12264 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012265 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012266 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012267 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012268 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012269
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012270 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012271
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012272
122738.2.5. Error log format
12274-----------------------
12275
12276When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12277protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12278By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12279"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12280will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12281logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12282
12283The format looks like this :
12284
12285 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12286 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12287 Connection error during SSL handshake
12288
12289 Field Format Extract from the example above
12290 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12291 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12292 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12293 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12294 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12295
12296These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12297failures.
12298
12299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123008.3. Advanced logging options
12301-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012302
12303Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12304just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12305options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12306for more information about their usage.
12307
12308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123098.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12310------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012311
12312It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12313haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12314commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12315monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12316ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12317
12318 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12319 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12320 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12321 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12322
12323 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12324 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12325 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012326 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012327 such as other load-balancers.
12328
12329 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12330 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12331 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12332
12333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123348.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12335----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012336
12337The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12338what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12339or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12340"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12341just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12342log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12343after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12344is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12345with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12346with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12347
12348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123498.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12350------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012351
12352Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12353for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12354"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12355retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12356raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12357a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12358file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12359you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12360"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12361
12362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123638.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12364--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012365
12366Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12367multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12368them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12369"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12370logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12371error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12372and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12373too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12374useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12375alternative.
12376
12377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123788.4. Timing events
12379------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012380
12381Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12382reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12383the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12384frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12385mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12386
12387 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12388 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12389 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12390 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12391 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12392
12393 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12394 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12395 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12396 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12397 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12398
12399 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12400 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12401 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12402 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12403 connection never established.
12404
12405 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12406 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12407 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12408 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12409 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12410 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12411 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12412 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12413 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12414 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12415 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12416
12417 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12418 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12419 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12420 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012421 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012422
12423 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12424
12425 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12426 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12427 negative.
12428
12429These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12430protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12431that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012432due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012433close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12434session has been aborted on timeout.
12435
12436Most common cases :
12437
12438 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12439 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12440 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12441 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12442 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12443 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12444 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12445 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12446 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012447 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12448 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12449 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012450
12451 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12452 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12453 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12454 of ms on remote networks.
12455
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012456 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12457 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12458 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012459
12460 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12461 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12462 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12463 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12464 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12465 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12466 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12467 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12468 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12469 to the server until another one is released.
12470
12471Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12472
12473 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12474 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12475 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12476
12477 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12478 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12479 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12480
12481 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12482 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12483 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12484 flags.
12485
12486 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12487 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12488 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12489 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12490 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12491 the client connection was maintained open.
12492
12493 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012494 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012495 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12496 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12497
12498
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124998.5. Session state at disconnection
12500-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012501
12502TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12503"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
125042-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12505each of which has a special meaning :
12506
12507 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12508 session to terminate :
12509
12510 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12511
12512 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12513 server explicitly refused it.
12514
12515 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12516 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12517 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12518 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012519 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12520
12521 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12522 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012523
12524 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12525 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12526 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12527 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12528 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12529
12530 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12531 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12532 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12533 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12534 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12535
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012536 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12537 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12538
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012539 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12540 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12541 backup connections when going up.
12542
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012543 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12544
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012545 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12546 send or receive data.
12547
12548 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12549 send or receive data.
12550
12551 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12552 with nothing left in the buffers.
12553
12554 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12555
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012556 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012557 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12558
12559 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12560 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12561 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12562 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12563 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12564
12565 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12566 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12567
12568 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12569 server (HTTP only).
12570
12571 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12572
12573 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12574 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12575 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12576
12577 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12578 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12579 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12580
12581 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12582
12583 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12584 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12585
12586 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12587 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12588 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12589
12590 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12591 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012592 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12593 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012594
12595 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12596 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12597 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12598 another server.
12599
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012600 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012601 server.
12602
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012603 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12604 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12605 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12606 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12607
12608 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12609 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12610 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12611 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12612
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012613 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12614 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12615 "use-server" rule).
12616
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012617 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12618
12619 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12620 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12621
12622 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12623
12624 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12625 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12626 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12627
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012628 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12629 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012630 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012631 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12632 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12633
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012634 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12635
12636 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12637 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12638
12639 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12640
12641 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12642
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012643The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12644was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012645helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12646starvation, attacks, etc...
12647
12648The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12649alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12650easier finding and understanding.
12651
12652 Flags Reason
12653
12654 -- Normal termination.
12655
12656 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12657 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12658 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12659 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12660
12661 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12662 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12663 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12664 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12665 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12666 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012667
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012668 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12669 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012670 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012671
12672 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12673 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12674 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12675
12676 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12677 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12678 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12679 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12680 the server takes too long to respond.
12681
12682 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12683 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12684 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12685 long a time to respond.
12686
12687 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12688 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12689 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12690 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12691 and the client.
12692
12693 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12694 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12695 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12696 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12697 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012698 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
12699 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
12700 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
12701 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
12702 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
12703 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
12704 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
12705 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
12706 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
12707 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
12708 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
12709 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
12710 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
12711 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012712
12713 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12714 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012715 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12716 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12717 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12718 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012719
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012720 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12721 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12722
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012723 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012724 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12725 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12726 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12727 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12728 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12729
12730 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12731 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12732 503 or 504 here.
12733
12734 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12735 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12736 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12737 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12738 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12739
12740 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12741 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012742 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012743 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12744 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12745
12746 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12747 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12748 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12749 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12750 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12751 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12752 between haproxy and the server.
12753
12754 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12755 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12756 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12757 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12758 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12759 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12760 solution is to fix the application.
12761
12762 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12763 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12764 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12765 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12766 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12767 external attacks.
12768
12769 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12770 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012771 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012772 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12773 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12774
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012775 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12776 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12777 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012778 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12779 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012780
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012781 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12782 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12783 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12784 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012785 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12786 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12787 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12788 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12789 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012790
12791 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12792 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12793 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12794 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12795
12796 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12797 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12798 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12799 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12800
12801 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12802 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12803 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12804 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12805
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012806The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12807persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12808important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12809re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12810
12811 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12812
12813 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12814 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12815 set on a GET request.
12816
12817 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12818 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012819 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012820 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12821
12822 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12823 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12824 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12825
12826 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12827 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12828 already got a cookie.
12829
12830 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12831 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12832 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12833 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12834 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12835
12836 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12837 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12838 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12839
12840 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12841 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12842 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12843
12844 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12845 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12846
12847 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12848 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12849 then advertised in the response.
12850
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012851
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128528.6. Non-printable characters
12853-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012854
12855In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12856consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12857converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12858prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12859being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12860escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12861is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12862'}' when logging headers.
12863
12864Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12865issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12866containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12867
12868Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12869the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12870performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12871
12872
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128738.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12874---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012875
12876Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12877achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012878section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012879cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12880the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12881the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012882locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012883not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12884user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12885a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12886wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12887
12888 Examples :
12889 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12890 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12891
12892 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12893 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12894
12895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12897---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012898
12899Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12900proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12901the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12902server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12903
12904Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12905response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012906section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012907
12908It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012909time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12910appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012911are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12912and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12913follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12914request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12915in the logs.
12916
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012917As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
12918frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
12919an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
12920
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012921 Example :
12922 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12923 listen proxy-out
12924 mode http
12925 option httplog
12926 option logasap
12927 log global
12928 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12929
12930 # log the name of the virtual server
12931 capture request header Host len 20
12932
12933 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12934 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12935
12936 # log the beginning of the referrer
12937 capture request header Referer len 20
12938
12939 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12940 capture response header Server len 20
12941
12942 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12943 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12944
12945 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12946 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12947
12948 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12949 capture response header Via len 20
12950
12951 # log the URL location during a redirection
12952 capture response header Location len 20
12953
12954 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12955 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12956 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12957 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12958 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12959
12960 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12961 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12962 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12963 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012964 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012965
12966 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12967 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12968 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12969 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12970 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012971 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012972
12973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129748.9. Examples of logs
12975---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012976
12977These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12978them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12979reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12980
12981 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12982 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12983 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12984
12985 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12986 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12987
12988 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12989 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12990 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12991
12992 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12993 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12994
12995 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12996 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12997 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12998
12999 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013000 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013001 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13002 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13003
13004 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13005 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13006 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13007
13008 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13009 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013010 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013011 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13012 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13013 to return the 502 and not the server.
13014
13015 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013016 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013017
13018 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13019 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13020 Nothing was sent to any server.
13021
13022 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13023 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13024
13025 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13026 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13027 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13028 send a 408 return code to the client.
13029
13030 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13031 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13032
13033 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13034 5 seconds ("c----").
13035
13036 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13037 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013038 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013039
13040 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013041 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013042 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13043 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13044 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13045 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13046 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013047
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130499. Statistics and monitoring
13050----------------------------
13051
13052It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13053mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13054CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13055Unix socket.
13056
13057
130589.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013059---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013060
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013061The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013062page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13063begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13064represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13065use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13066('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13067(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13068text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13069do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13070use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013071
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013072 0. pxname: proxy name
13073 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
13074 for server)
13075 2. qcur: current queued requests
13076 3. qmax: max queued requests
13077 4. scur: current sessions
13078 5. smax: max sessions
13079 6. slim: sessions limit
13080 7. stot: total sessions
13081 8. bin: bytes in
13082 9. bout: bytes out
13083 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013084 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013085 12. ereq: request errors
13086 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010013087 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013088 15. wretr: retries (warning)
13089 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010013090 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013091 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13092 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13093 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13094 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
13095 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
13096 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
13097 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
13098 25. qlimit: queue limit
13099 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13100 27. iid: unique proxy id
13101 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
13102 29. throttle: warm up status
13103 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
13104 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020013105 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020013106 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13107 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
13108 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020013109 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013110 UNK -> unknown
13111 INI -> initializing
13112 SOCKERR -> socket error
13113 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13114 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13115 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13116 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13117 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13118 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13119 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13120 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13121 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13122 disable-on-404
13123 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13124 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13125 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020013126 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
13127 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013128 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
13129 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
13130 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
13131 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
13132 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
13133 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013134 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
13135 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13136 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13137 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010013138 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13139 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010013140 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13141 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13142 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010013143 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010013144 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreaua28df3e2014-06-16 16:40:14 +020013145 56. last_chk: last health check contents or textual error
13146 57. last_agt: last agent check contents or textual error
Willy Tarreauf5b1cc32014-06-17 12:20:59 +020013147 58. qtime: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13148 59. ctime: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13149 60. rtime: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests (0 for TCP)
13150 61. ttime: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013151
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131539.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013154-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013155
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013156The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13157necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13158A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13159issuing commands by hand :
13160
13161 global
13162 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13163 stats timeout 2m
13164
13165It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13166the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13167never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13168situations :
13169
13170 global
13171 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13172 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13173 stats timeout 2m
13174
13175To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13176swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13177to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13178syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13179
13180 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13181 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13182
13183The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13184script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13185for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13186
13187The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13188that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13189editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13190(eg: watch a counter).
13191
13192The socket supports two operation modes :
13193 - interactive
13194 - non-interactive
13195
13196The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13197this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13198sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13199mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13200commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13201example :
13202
13203 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13204
13205The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13206entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13207for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13208sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13209"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13210after processing the last command of the same line.
13211
13212For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13213"prompt" command :
13214
13215 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13216 prompt
13217 > show info
13218 ...
13219 >
13220
13221Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13222delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13223that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13224parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013225
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013226It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13227on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13228own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013229
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013230The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13231If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13232all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13233it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13234
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013235add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013236 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13237 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13238 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13239 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013240
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013241add map <map> <key> <value>
13242 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13243 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013244 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13245 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13246 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013247
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013248clear counters
13249 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13250 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13251 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13252 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13253 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13254
13255clear counters all
13256 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13257 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13258 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13259
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013260clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013261 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13262 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13263 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013264
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013265clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013266 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13267 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13268 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013269
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013270clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13271 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13272
13273 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13274 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13275 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13276 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13277 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13278 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13279
13280 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13281
13282 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13283 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13284 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13285 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13286 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13287 the ACLs :
13288
13289 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13290 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13291 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13292 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13293 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13294 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13295
13296 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013297 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13298 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013299
13300 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013301 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013302 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013303 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13304 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13305 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13306 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013307
13308 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13309
13310 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013311 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013312 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13313 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013314 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13315 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13316 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013317
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013318del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13319 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013320 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13321 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13322 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13323 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013324
13325del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013326 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013327 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13328 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13329 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13330 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013331
13332disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013333 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13334
13335 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13336 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13337 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13338 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13339 re-enabled using enable agent.
13340
13341 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13342 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13343 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13344 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13345 otherwise unchanged.
13346
13347 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13348 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13349 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13350
13351 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13352 level "admin".
13353
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013354disable frontend <frontend>
13355 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13356 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13357 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13358 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13359 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13360 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13361 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13362 on the stats page.
13363
13364 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13365 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13366
13367 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13368 level "admin".
13369
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013370disable health <backend>/<server>
13371 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13372 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13373 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13374 agent check forces it down.
13375
13376 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13377 level "admin".
13378
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013379disable server <backend>/<server>
13380 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13381 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13382 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13383 during the maintenance.
13384
13385 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13386 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13387
13388 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013389 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013390
13391 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13392 level "admin".
13393
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013394enable agent <backend>/<server>
13395 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13396
13397 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13398 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13399
13400 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13401 level "admin".
13402
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013403enable frontend <frontend>
13404 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13405 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13406 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13407 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13408 which was disabled.
13409
13410 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13411 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13412
13413 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13414 level "admin".
13415
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013416enable health <backend>/<server>
13417 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13418 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13419
13420 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13421 level "admin".
13422
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013423enable server <backend>/<server>
13424 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13425 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13426
13427 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013428 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013429
13430 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13431 level "admin".
13432
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013433get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013434get acl <acl> <value>
13435 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13436 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13437 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13438 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13439 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013440
13441 The first two words are:
13442
13443 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13444 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13445 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13446
13447 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13448
13449 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13450
13451 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13452
13453 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13454 interpretation of the case.
13455
13456 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13457 useful with regular expressions.
13458
13459 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13460 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13461
13462 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13463 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13464 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13465
13466 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13467
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013468get weight <backend>/<server>
13469 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13470 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13471 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13472 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13473 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013474 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013475
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013476help
13477 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13478 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013479
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013480prompt
13481 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13482 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13483 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13484 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13485 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13486 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13487 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13488 command.
13489
13490quit
13491 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013492
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013493set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013494 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13495 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13496 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013497
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013498set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013499 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13500 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13501 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13502 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13503 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013504 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13505 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13506
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013507set maxconn global <maxconn>
13508 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13509 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13510 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13511 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13512 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13513 setting.
13514
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013515set rate-limit connections global <value>
13516 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13517 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13518 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13519 is passed in number of connections per second.
13520
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013521set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13522 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13523 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013524 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13525 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013526
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013527set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13528 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13529 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13530 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13531 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13532
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013533set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13534 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13535 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13536 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13537 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13538 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13539
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013540set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13541 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13542 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13543 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13544
13545set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13546 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13547 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13548 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13549
13550set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13551 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13552 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13553 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13554 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13555 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13556 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13557 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13558 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13559
13560set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13561 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13562 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13563
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013564set ssl ocsp-response <response>
13565 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
13566 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
13567 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
13568 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
13569
13570 Example:
13571 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
13572 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
13573 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
13574 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
13575
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013576set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013577 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13578 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13579 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13580 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013581 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13582 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013583
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013584set timeout cli <delay>
13585 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13586 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13587 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13588
13589set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13590 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13591 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013592 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13593 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13594 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13595 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13596 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13597 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13598 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13599 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13600 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13601 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13602 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13603 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13604 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013605
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013606show errors [<iid>]
13607 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13608 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013609 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13610 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13611 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013612
13613 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13614 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13615 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13616 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13617 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13618 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13619 are reported too.
13620
13621 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13622 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13623 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13624 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13625 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13626 code.
13627
13628 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13629 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13630 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13631 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13632 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13633 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13634 line.
13635
13636 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013637 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13638 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013639 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13640 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13641
13642 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13643 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13644 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13645 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13646 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13647 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13648 00204+ minal\r\n
13649 00211 \r\n
13650
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013651 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013652 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13653 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13654 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13655 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13656 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13657 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013658
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013659show info
13660 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13661
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013662show map [<map>]
13663 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013664 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13665 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13666 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13667 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13668 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13669 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013670
13671show acl [<acl>]
13672 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013673 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13674 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13675 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13676 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13677 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013678
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013679show pools
13680 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13681 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13682 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13683 the pools.
13684
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013685show sess
13686 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013687 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13688 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13689
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013690show sess <id>
13691 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13692 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13693 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13694 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13695 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013696 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13697 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13698 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013699
13700show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13701 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13702 possible to dump only selected items :
13703 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13704 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13705 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13706 for example:
13707 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13708 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13709 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13710
13711 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013712 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13713 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013714 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13715 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13716 Nbproc: 1
13717 Process_num: 1
13718 (...)
13719
13720 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13721 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13722 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13723 (...)
13724 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13725
13726 $
13727
13728 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13729 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13730 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13731 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013732 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013733
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013734show table
13735 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13736 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13737 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13738 entries currently in use.
13739
13740 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013741 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013742 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13743 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013744
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013745show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013746 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13747 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13748 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013749 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13750
13751 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13752 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13753 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13754 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13755 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13756
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013757 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13758 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13759 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13760 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13761 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13762 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13763
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013764
13765 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013766 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13767 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013768
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013769 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013770 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013771 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013772 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13773 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13774 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13775 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013776
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013777 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013778 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013779 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13780 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013781
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013782 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13783 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013784 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013785 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13786 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013787
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013788 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13789 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013790 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013791 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13792 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13793
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013794 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13795 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13796 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13797 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13798 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13799
13800 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13801 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13802 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013803 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13804 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013805 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13806 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013807
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013808shutdown frontend <frontend>
13809 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13810 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13811 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13812 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13813 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13814 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13815 once it is terminated.
13816
13817 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13818 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13819
13820 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13821 level "admin".
13822
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013823shutdown session <id>
13824 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13825 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13826 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13827 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13828 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13829 flag in the logs.
13830
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013831shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13832 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13833 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13834 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13835 'K' flag in the logs.
13836
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013837/*
13838 * Local variables:
13839 * fill-column: 79
13840 * End:
13841 */